S25FL256SAGMFMG13 [CYPRESS]
Flash, 64MX4, PDSO16, SOIC-16;型号: | S25FL256SAGMFMG13 |
厂家: | CYPRESS |
描述: | Flash, 64MX4, PDSO16, SOIC-16 时钟 光电二极管 内存集成电路 |
文件: | 总149页 (文件大小:4642K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
128 Mbit (16 Mbyte)/256 Mbit (32 Mbyte)
3.0V SPI Flash Memory
Features
CMOS 3.0 Volt Core with Versatile I/O
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) with Multi-I/O
– SPI Clock polarity and phase modes 0 and 3
– Double Data Rate (DDR) option
Cycling Endurance
– 100,000 Program-Erase Cycles, minimum
Data Retention
– 20 Year Data Retention, minimum
– Extended Addressing: 24- or 32-bit address options
– Serial Command set and footprint compatible with
S25FL-A, S25FL-K, and S25FL-P SPI families
– Multi I/O Command set and footprint compatible with
S25FL-P SPI family
Security features
– One Time Program (OTP) array of 1024 bytes
– Block Protection:
– Status Register bits to control protection against
program or erase of a contiguous range of sectors.
– Hardware and software control options
– Advanced Sector Protection (ASP)
– Individual sector protection controlled by boot code or
password
READ Commands
– Normal, Fast, Dual, Quad, Fast DDR, Dual DDR, Quad
DDR
– AutoBoot - power up or reset and execute a Normal or
Quad read command automatically at a preselected
address
– Common Flash Interface (CFI) data for configuration
information.
Cypress® 65 nm MirrorBit® Technology with Eclipse™
Architecture
Core Supply Voltage: 2.7V to 3.6V
I/O Supply Voltage: 1.65V to 3.6V
– SO16 and FBGA packages
Programming (1.5 Mbytes/s)
– 256 or 512 Byte Page Programming buffer options
– Quad-Input Page Programming (QPP) for slow clock
systems
– Automatic ECC -internal hardware Error Correction Code
generation with single bit error correction
Temperature Range / Grade:
– Industrial (-40°C to +85°C)
– Industrial Plus (-40°C to +105°C)
– Automotive AEC-Q100 Grade 3 (-40°C to +85°C)
– Automotive AEC-Q100 Grade 2 (-40°C to +105°C)
– Automotive AEC-Q100 Grade 1 (-40°C to +125°C)
Erase (0.5 to 0.65 Mbytes/s)
– Hybrid sector size option - physical set of thirty two 4-kbyte
sectors at top or bottom of address space with all
remaining sectors of 64 kbytes, for compatibility with prior
generation S25FL devices
Packages (all Pb-free)
– 16-lead SOIC (300 mil)
– WSON 6 x 8 mm
– BGA-24 6 x 8 mm
– Uniform sector option - always erase 256-kbyte blocks for
software compatibility with higher density and future
devices.
– 5 x 5 ball (FAB024) and 4 x 6 ball (FAC024) footprint
options
Cypress Semiconductor Corporation
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
•
198 Champion Court
•
San Jose, CA 95134-1709
•
408-943-2600
Revised May 23, 2017
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
– Known Good Die and Known Tested Die
Logic Block Diagram
CS#
SRAM
SCK
MirrorBit Array
SI/IO0
SO/IO1
WP#/IO2
Y Decoders
Data Latch
I/O
Control
Logic
HOLD#/IO3
Data Path
RESET#
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 2 of 146
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Performance Summary
Maximum Read Rates with the Same Core and I/O Voltage (VIO = VCC = 2.7V to 3.6V)
Command
Clock Rate (MHz)
50
Mbytes/s
6.25
16.6
26
Read
Fast Read
Dual Read
Quad Read
133
104
104
52
Maximum Read Rates with Lower I/O Voltage (VIO = 1.65V to 2.7V, VCC = 2.7V to 3.6V)
Command Clock Rate (MHz)
Mbytes/s
6.25
Read
50
66
66
66
Fast Read
Dual Read
Quad Read
8.25
16.5
33
Maximum Read Rates DDR (VIO = VCC = 3V to 3.6V)
Command
Fast Read DDR
Clock Rate (MHz)
Mbytes/s
80
80
80
20
40
80
Dual Read DDR
Quad Read DDR
Typical Program and Erase Rates
Operation
kbytes/s
1000
1500
30
Page Programming (256-byte page buffer - Hybrid Sector Option)
Page Programming (512-byte page buffer - Uniform Sector Option)
4-kbyte Physical Sector Erase (Hybrid Sector Option)
64-kbyte Physical Sector Erase (Hybrid Sector Option)
256-kbyte Logical Sector Erase (Uniform Sector Option)
500
500
Current Consumption
Operation
Current (mA)
16 (max)
Serial Read 50 MHz
Serial Read 133 MHz
Quad Read 104 MHz
Quad DDR Read 80 MHz
Program
33 (max)
61 (max)
90 (max)
100 (max)
100 (max)
0.07 (typ)
Erase
Standby
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 3 of 146
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Contents
1.
Overview....................................................................... 4
Software Interface
7. Address Space Maps.................................................. 44
7.1 Overview....................................................................... 44
7.2 Flash Memory Array...................................................... 44
7.3 ID-CFI Address Space.................................................. 46
7.4 OTP Address Space..................................................... 46
7.5 Registers....................................................................... 48
1.1 General Description ....................................................... 4
1.2 Migration Notes.............................................................. 5
1.3 Glossary......................................................................... 7
1.4 Other Resources............................................................ 7
Hardware Interface
2.
Signal Descriptions ..................................................... 8
2.1 Input/Output Summary................................................... 8
2.2 Address and Data Configuration.................................... 9
2.3 RESET#......................................................................... 9
2.4 Serial Clock (SCK)......................................................... 9
2.5 Chip Select (CS#) .......................................................... 9
2.6 Serial Input (SI) / IO0 ................................................... 10
2.7 Serial Output (SO) / IO1............................................... 10
2.8 Write Protect (WP#) / IO2 ............................................ 10
2.9 Hold (HOLD#) / IO3 ..................................................... 10
2.10 Core Voltage Supply (VCC).......................................... 11
2.11 Versatile I/O Power Supply (VIO) ................................. 11
2.12 Supply and Signal Ground (VSS) ................................. 11
2.13 Not Connected (NC) .................................................... 11
2.14 Reserved for Future Use (RFU)................................... 11
2.15 Do Not Use (DNU) ....................................................... 11
2.16 Block Diagrams............................................................ 12
8.
Data Protection ........................................................... 58
8.1 Secure Silicon Region (OTP)........................................ 58
8.2 Write Enable Command................................................ 58
8.3 Block Protection............................................................ 59
8.4 Advanced Sector Protection ......................................... 60
9.
Commands .................................................................. 64
9.1 Command Set Summary............................................... 65
9.2 Identification Commands .............................................. 71
9.3 Register Access Commands......................................... 73
9.4 Read Memory Array Commands .................................. 84
9.5 Program Flash Array Commands ............................... 100
9.6 Erase Flash Array Commands.................................... 106
9.7 One Time Program Array Commands ........................ 111
9.8 Advanced Sector Protection Commands.................... 112
9.9 Reset Commands....................................................... 118
9.10 Embedded Algorithm Performance Tables................. 119
3.
Signal Protocols......................................................... 13
10. Data Integrity............................................................. 121
10.1 Erase Endurance........................................................ 121
10.2 Data Retention............................................................ 121
3.1 SPI Clock Modes ......................................................... 13
3.2 Command Protocol ...................................................... 14
3.3 Interface States............................................................ 18
3.4 Configuration Register Effects on the Interface ........... 22
3.5 Data Protection ............................................................ 22
11. Software Interface Reference .................................. 122
11.1 Command Summary................................................... 122
11.2 Device ID and Common Flash Interface
(ID-CFI) Address Map................................................. 124
11.3 Device ID and Common Flash Interface
(ID-CFI) ASO Map — Automotive Only ...................... 137
11.4 Registers..................................................................... 137
11.5 Initial Delivery State.................................................... 140
4.
Electrical Specifications............................................ 23
4.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ......................................... 23
4.2 Thermal Resistance..................................................... 23
4.3 Operating Ranges........................................................ 23
4.4 Power-Up and Power-Down ........................................ 25
4.5 DC Characteristics....................................................... 26
12. Ordering Information................................................ 141
13. Contacting Cypress.................................................. 143
5.
Timing Specifications................................................ 28
5.1 Key to Switching Waveforms ....................................... 28
5.2 AC Test Conditions...................................................... 28
5.3 Reset............................................................................ 29
5.4 SDR AC Characteristics............................................... 31
5.5 DDR AC Characteristics .............................................. 35
14. Revision History........................................................ 144
Sales, Solutions, and Legal Information ........................ 148
Worldwide Sales and Design Support ......................... 148
Products ...................................................................... 148
PSoC® Solutions ........................................................ 148
Cypress Developer Community ................................... 148
Technical Support ....................................................... 148
6.
Physical Interface ...................................................... 37
6.1 SOIC 16-Lead Package............................................... 37
6.2 WSON Package........................................................... 39
6.3 FAB024 24-Ball BGA Package .................................... 40
6.4 FAC024 24-Ball BGA Package.................................... 42
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 3 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
1. Overview
1.1
General Description
The Cypress S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices are flash non-volatile memory products using:
MirrorBit technology - that stores two data bits in each memory array transistor
Eclipse architecture - that dramatically improves program and erase performance
65 nm process lithography
This family of devices connect to a host system via a Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI). Traditional SPI single bit serial input and
output (Single I/O or SIO) is supported as well as optional two bit (Dual I/O or DIO) and four bit (Quad I/O or QIO) serial commands.
This multiple width interface is called SPI Multi-I/O or MIO. In addition, the FL-S family adds support for Double Data Rate (DDR)
read commands for SIO, DIO, and QIO that transfer address and read data on both edges of the clock.
The Eclipse architecture features a Page Programming Buffer that allows up to 128 words (256 bytes) or 256 words (512 bytes) to
be programmed in one operation, resulting in faster effective programming and erase than prior generation SPI program or erase
algorithms.
Executing code directly from flash memory is often called Execute-In-Place or XIP. By using FL-S devices at the higher clock rates
supported, with QIO or DDR-QIO commands, the instruction read transfer rate can match or exceed traditional parallel interface,
asynchronous, NOR flash memories while reducing signal count dramatically.
The S25FL128S and S25FL256S products offer high densities coupled with the flexibility and fast performance required by a variety
of embedded applications. They are ideal for code shadowing, XIP, and data storage.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 4 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
1.2
Migration Notes
1.2.1 Features Comparison
The S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices are command set and footprint compatible with prior generation FL-K and FL-P families.
Table 1. FL Generations Comparison
Parameter
Technology Node
FL-K
FL-P
FL-S
65 nm
90 nm
90 nm
Architecture
Floating Gate
MirrorBit
MirrorBit Eclipse
2H2011
Release Date
In Production
In Production
Density
4 Mb - 128 Mb
32 Mb - 256 Mb
128 Mb - 256 Mb
x1, x2, x4
Bus Width
x1, x2, x4
x1, x2, x4
Supply Voltage
2.7V - 3.6V
2.7V - 3.6V
2.7V - 3.6V / 1.65V - 3.6V VIO
6 MB/s (50 MHz)
17 MB/s (133 MHz)
26 MB/s (104 MHz)
52 MB/s (104 MHz)
20 MB/s (80 MHz)
40 MB/s (80 MHz)
80 MB/s (80 MHz)
256B / 512B
Normal Read Speed (SDR)
Fast Read Speed (SDR)
Dual Read Speed (SDR)
Quad Read Speed (SDR)
Fast Read Speed (DDR)
Dual Read Speed (DDR)
Quad Read Speed (DDR)
Program Buffer Size
Erase Sector Size
6 MB/s (50 MHz)
5 MB/s (40 MHz)
13 MB/s (104 MHz)
13 MB/s (104 MHz)
26 MB/s (104 MHz)
20 MB/s (80 MHz)
52 MB/s (104 MHz)
40 MB/s (80 MHz)
256B
256B
4 kB / 32 kB / 64 kB
64 kB / 256 kB
64 kB / 256 kB
4 kB (option)
Parameter Sector Size
Sector Erase Time (typ.)
Page Programming Time (typ.)
OTP
4 kB
4 kB
30 ms (4 kB), 150 ms (64 kB)
500 ms (64 kB)
130 ms (64 kB), 520 ms (256 kB)
250 µs (256B), 340 µs (512B)
1024B
700 µs (256B)
1500 µs (256B)
768B (3 x 256B)
506B
No
Advanced Sector Protection
Auto Boot Mode
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
Erase Suspend/Resume
Program Suspend/Resume
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
40°C to +85°C /
+105°C / +125°C
Operating Temperature
40°C to +85°C
40°C to +85°C / +105°C
Notes:
1. 256B program page option only for 128-Mb and 256-Mb density FL-S devices.
2. FL-P column indicates FL129P MIO SPI device (for 128-Mb density).
3. 64-kB sector erase option only for 128-Mb/256-Mb density FL-P and FL-S devices.
4. FL-K family devices can erase 4-kB sectors in groups of 32 kB or 64 kB.
5. Refer to individual data sheets for further details.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 5 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
1.2.2 Known Differences from Prior Generations
1.2.2.1 Error Reporting
Prior generation FL memories either do not have error status bits or do not set them if program or erase is attempted on a protected
sector. The FL-S family does have error reporting status bits for program and erase operations. These can be set when there is an
internal failure to program or erase or when there is an attempt to program or erase a protected sector. In either case the program or
erase operation did not complete as requested by the command.
1.2.2.2 Secure Silicon Region (OTP)
The size and format (address map) of the One Time Program area is different from prior generations. The method for protecting
each portion of the OTP area is different. For additional details see Section 8.1 Secure Silicon Region (OTP) on page 58.
1.2.2.3 Configuration Register Freeze Bit
The configuration register Freeze bit CR1[0], locks the state of the Block Protection bits as in prior generations. In the FL-S family it
also locks the state of the configuration register TBPARM bit CR1[2], TBPROT bit CR1[5], and the Secure Silicon Region (OTP)
area.
1.2.2.4 Sector Erase Commands
The command for erasing an 8-kbyte area (two 4-kbyte sectors) is not supported.
The command for erasing a 4-kbyte sector is supported only in the 128-Mbit and 256-Mbit density FL-S devices and only for use on
the thirty two 4-kbyte parameter sectors at the top or bottom of the device address space.
The erase command for 64-kbyte sectors are supported for the 128-Mbit and 256-Mbit density FL-S devices when the ordering
option for 4-kbyte parameter sectors with 64-kbyte uniform sectors are used. The 64-kbyte erase command may be applied to erase
a group of sixteen 4-kbyte sectors.
The erase command for a 256-kbyte sector replaces the 64-kbyte erase command when the ordering option for 256-kbyte uniform
sectors is used for the 128-Mbit and 256-Mbit density FL-S devices.
1.2.2.5 Deep Power Down
The Deep Power Down (DPD) function is not supported in FL-S family devices.
The legacy DPD (B9h) command code is instead used to enable legacy SPI memory controllers, that can issue the former DPD
command, to access a new bank address register. The bank address register allows SPI memory controllers that do not support
more than 24 bits of address, the ability to provide higher order address bits for commands, as needed to access the larger address
space of the 256-Mbit density FL-S device. For additional information see Section 7.1.1 Extended Address on page 44.
1.2.2.6 New Features
The FL-S family introduces several new features to SPI category memories:
Extended address for access to higher memory density.
AutoBoot for simpler access to boot code following power up.
Enhanced High Performance read commands using mode bits to eliminate the overhead of SIO instructions when repeating the
same type of read command.
Multiple options for initial read latency (number of dummy cycles) for faster initial access time or higher clock rate read
commands.
DDR read commands for SIO, DIO, and QIO.
Automatic ECC for enhanced data integrity.
Advanced Sector Protection for individually controlling the protection of each sector. This is very similar to the Advanced Sector
Protection feature found in several other Cypress parallel interface NOR memory families.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 6 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
1.3
Glossary
All information transferred between the host system and memory during one period while CS# is low. This includes the instruction
(sometimes called an operation code or opcode) and any required address, mode bits, latency cycles, or data.
Command
DDP
Two die stacked within the same package to increase the memory capacity of a single package. Often also referred to as a Multi-Chip
Package (MCP)
(Dual Die Package)
DDR
When input and output are latched on every edge of SCK.
(Double Data Rate)
ECC Unit = 16 byte aligned and length data groups in the main Flash array and OTP array, each of which has its own hidden ECC
syndrome to enable error correction on each group.
ECC
The name for a type of Electrical Erase Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) that erases large blocks of memory bits in
parallel, making the erase operation much faster than early EEPROM.
Flash
A signal voltage level ≥ V or a logic level representing a binary one (1).
High
IH
The 8 bit code indicating the function to be performed by a command (sometimes called an operation code or opcode). The instruction
is always the first 8 bits transferred from host system to the memory in any command.
Instruction
Low
A signal voltage level V or a logic level representing a binary zero (0).
IL
LSB
Generally the right most bit, with the lowest order of magnitude value, within a group of bits of a register or data value.
(Least Significant Bit)
MSB
Generally the left most bit, with the highest order of magnitude value, within a group of bits of a register or data value.
No power is needed to maintain data stored in the memory.
(Most Significant Bit)
Non-Volatile
OPN
The alphanumeric string specifying the memory device type, density, package, factory non-volatile configuration, etc. used to select the
desired device.
(Ordering Part Number)
512 bytes or 256 bytes aligned and length group of data. The size assigned for a page depends on the Ordering Part Number.
Printed Circuit Board
Page
PCB
Production Part Approval Process
PPAP
Are in the format: Register_name[bit_number] or Register_name[bit_range_MSB: bit_range_LSB]
Register Bit References
SDR
When input is latched on the rising edge and output on the falling edge of SCK.
(Single Data Rate)
Erase unit size; depending on device model and sector location this may be 4 kbytes, 64 kbytes or 256 kbytes.
Sector
An operation that changes data within volatile or non-volatile registers bits or non-volatile flash memory. When changing non-volatile
data, an erase and reprogramming of any unchanged non-volatile data is done, as part of the operation, such that the non-volatile data
is modified by the write operation, in the same way that volatile data is modified – as a single operation. The non-volatile data appears
to the host system to be updated by the single write command, without the need for separate commands for erase and reprogram of
adjacent, but unaffected data.
Write
1.4
Other Resources
1.4.1 Cypress Flash Memory Roadmap
www.cypress.com/product-roadmaps/cypress-flash-memory-roadmap
1.4.2 Links to Software
www.cypress.com/software-and-drivers-cypress-flash-memory
1.4.3 Links to Application Notes
www.cypress.com/appnotes
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 7 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Hardware Interface
Serial Peripheral Interface with Multiple Input / Output (SPI-MIO)
Many memory devices connect to their host system with separate parallel control, address, and data signals that require a large
number of signal connections and larger package size. The large number of connections increase power consumption due to so
many signals switching and the larger package increases cost.
The S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices reduce the number of signals for connection to the host system by serially transferring all
control, address, and data information over 4 to 6 signals. This reduces the cost of the memory package, reduces signal switching
power, and either reduces the host connection count or frees host connectors for use in providing other features.
The S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices use the industry standard single bit Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) and also supports
optional extension commands for two bit (Dual) and four bit (Quad) wide serial transfers. This multiple width interface is called SPI
Multi-I/O or SPI-MIO.
2. Signal Descriptions
2.1
Input/Output Summary
Table 2. Signal List
Signal
Name
Type
Description
Hardware Reset: Low = device resets and returns to standby state, ready to receive a command. The
signal has an internal pull-up resistor and may be left unconnected in the host system if not used.
RESET#
Input
SCK
CS#
Input
Input
I/O
Serial Clock
Chip Select
SI / IO0
SO / IO1
Serial Input for single bit data commands or IO0 for Dual or Quad commands.
Serial Output for single bit data commands. IO1 for Dual or Quad commands.
I/O
Write Protect when not in Quad mode. IO2 in Quad mode. The signal has an internal pull-up resistor
and may be left unconnected in the host system if not used for Quad commands.
WP# / IO2
I/O
Hold (pause) serial transfer in single bit or Dual data commands. IO3 in Quad-I/O mode. The signal
has an internal pull-up resistor and may be left unconnected in the host system if not used for Quad
commands.
HOLD# /
IO3
I/O
VCC
VIO
Supply
Supply
Supply
Core Power Supply.
Versatile I/O Power Supply.
Ground.
VSS
Not Connected. No device internal signal is connected to the package connector nor is there any
future plan to use the connector for a signal. The connection may safely be used for routing space for
a signal on a Printed Circuit Board (PCB). However, any signal connected to an NC must not have
voltage levels higher than VIO.
NC
Unused
Reserved for Future Use. No device internal signal is currently connected to the package connector
but there is potential future use of the connector for a signal. It is recommended to not use RFU
connectors for PCB routing channels so that the PCB may take advantage of future enhanced features
in compatible footprint devices.
RFU
Reserved
Do Not Use. A device internal signal may be connected to the package connector. The connection
may be used by Cypress for test or other purposes and is not intended for connection to any host
system signal. Any DNU signal related function will be inactive when the signal is at VIL. The signal has
DNU
Reserved
an internal pull-down resistor and may be left unconnected in the host system or may be tied to VSS
.
Do not use these connections for PCB signal routing channels. Do not connect any host system signal
to this connection.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 8 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
2.2
Address and Data Configuration
Traditional SPI single bit wide commands (Single or SIO) send information from the host to the memory only on the SI signal. Data
may be sent back to the host serially on the Serial Output (SO) signal.
Dual or Quad Output commands send information from the host to the memory only on the SI signal. Data will be returned to the
host as a sequence of bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or four bit (nibble) groups on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3.
Dual or Quad Input/Output (I/O) commands send information from the host to the memory as bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or four bit
(nibble) groups on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3. Data is returned to the host similarly as bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or four bit (nibble) groups
on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3.
2.3
RESET#
The RESET# input provides a hardware method of resetting the device to standby state, ready for receiving a command. When
RESET# is driven to logic low (VIL) for at least a period of tRP, the device:
terminates any operation in progress,
tristates all outputs,
resets the volatile bits in the Configuration Register,
resets the volatile bits in the Status Registers,
resets the Bank Address Register to zero,
loads the Program Buffer with all ones,
reloads all internal configuration information necessary to bring the device to standby mode,
and resets the internal Control Unit to standby state.
RESET# causes the same initialization process as is performed when power comes up and requires tPU time.
RESET# may be asserted low at any time. To ensure data integrity any operation that was interrupted by a hardware reset should
be reinitiated once the device is ready to accept a command sequence.
When RESET# is first asserted Low, the device draws ICC1 (50 MHz value) during tPU. If RESET# continues to be held at VSS the
device draws CMOS standby current (ISB).
RESET# has an internal pull-up resistor and may be left unconnected in the host system if not used.
The RESET# input is not available on all packages options. When not available the RESET# input of the device is tied to the inactive
state, inside the package.
2.4
Serial Clock (SCK)
This input signal provides the synchronization reference for the SPI interface. Instructions, addresses, or data input are latched on
the rising edge of the SCK signal. Data output changes after the falling edge of SCK, in SDR commands, and after every edge in
DDR commands.
2.5
Chip Select (CS#)
The chip select signal indicates when a command for the device is in process and the other signals are relevant for the memory
device. When the CS# signal is at the logic high state, the device is not selected and all input signals are ignored and all output
signals are high impedance. Unless an internal Program, Erase or Write Registers (WRR) embedded operation is in progress, the
device will be in the Standby Power mode. Driving the CS# input to logic low state enables the device, placing it in the Active Power
mode. After Power-up, a falling edge on CS# is required prior to the start of any command.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 9 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
2.6
Serial Input (SI) / IO0
This input signal is used to transfer data serially into the device. It receives instructions, addresses, and data to be programmed.
Values are latched on the rising edge of serial SCK clock signal.
SI becomes IO0 - an input and output during Dual and Quad commands for receiving instructions, addresses, and data to be
programmed (values latched on rising edge of serial SCK clock signal) as well as shifting out data (on the falling edge of SCK, in
SDR commands, and on every edge of SCK, in DDR commands).
2.7
Serial Output (SO) / IO1
This output signal is used to transfer data serially out of the device. Data is shifted out on the falling edge of the serial SCK clock
signal.
SO becomes IO1 - an input and output during Dual and Quad commands for receiving addresses, and data to be programmed
(values latched on rising edge of serial SCK clock signal) as well as shifting out data (on the falling edge of SCK, in SDR commands,
and on every edge of SCK, in DDR commands).
2.8
Write Protect (WP#) / IO2
When WP# is driven Low (VIL), during a WRR command and while the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit of the Status
Register is set to a 1, it is not possible to write to the Status and Configuration Registers. This prevents any alteration of the Block
Protect (BP2, BP1, BP0) and TBPROT bits of the Status Register. As a consequence, all the data bytes in the memory area that are
protected by the Block Protect and TBPROT bits, are also hardware protected against data modification if WP# is Low during a
WRR command.
The WP# function is not available when the Quad mode is enabled (CR[1]=1). The WP# function is replaced by IO2 for input and
output during Quad mode for receiving addresses, and data to be programmed (values are latched on rising edge of the SCK signal)
as well as shifting out data (on the falling edge of SCK, in SDR commands, and on every edge of SCK, in DDR commands).
WP# has an internal pull-up resistor; when unconnected, WP# is at VIH and may be left unconnected in the host system if not used
for Quad mode.
2.9
Hold (HOLD#) / IO3
The Hold (HOLD#) signal is used to pause any serial communications with the device without deselecting the device or stopping the
serial clock.
To enter the Hold condition, the device must be selected by driving the CS# input to the logic low state. It is recommended that the
user keep the CS# input low state during the entire duration of the Hold condition. This is to ensure that the state of the interface
logic remains unchanged from the moment of entering the Hold condition. If the CS# input is driven to the logic high state while the
device is in the Hold condition, the interface logic of the device will be reset. To restart communication with the device, it is
necessary to drive HOLD# to the logic high state while driving the CS# signal into the logic low state. This prevents the device from
going back into the Hold condition.
The Hold condition starts on the falling edge of the Hold (HOLD#) signal, provided that this coincides with SCK being at the logic low
state. If the falling edge does not coincide with the SCK signal being at the logic low state, the Hold condition starts whenever the
SCK signal reaches the logic low state. Taking the HOLD# signal to the logic low state does not terminate any Write, Program or
Erase operation that is currently in progress.
During the Hold condition, SO is in high impedance and both the SI and SCK input are Don't Care.
The Hold condition ends on the rising edge of the Hold (HOLD#) signal, provided that this coincides with the SCK signal being at the
logic low state. If the rising edge does not coincide with the SCK signal being at the logic low state, the Hold condition ends
whenever the SCK signal reaches the logic low state.
The HOLD# function is not available when the Quad mode is enabled (CR1[1] =1). The Hold function is replaced by IO3 for input
and output during Quad mode for receiving addresses, and data to be programmed (values are latched on rising edge of the SCK
signal) as well as shifting out data (on the falling edge of SCK, in SDR commands, and on every edge of SCK, in DDR commands).
The HOLD# signal has an internal pull-up resistor and may be left unconnected in the host system if not used for Quad mode.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 10 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 1. HOLD Mode Operation
CS#
SCK
HOLD#
Hold Condition
Standard Use
Hold Condition
Non-standard Use
SI_or_IO_(during_input)
SO_or_IO_(internal)
SO_or_IO_(external)
Valid Input
Don't Care
Valid Input
B C
Don't Care
Valid Input
D
A
B
C
D
E
E
A
B
2.10 Core Voltage Supply (V )
CC
VCC is the voltage source for all device internal logic. It is the single voltage used for all device internal functions including read,
program, and erase. The voltage may vary from 2.7V to 3.6V.
2.11 Versatile I/O Power Supply (V )
IO
The Versatile I/O (VIO) supply is the voltage source for all device input receivers and output drivers and allows the host system to set
the voltage levels that the device tolerates on all inputs and drives on outputs (address, control, and IO signals). The VIO range is
1.65V to VCC. VIO cannot be greater than VCC
.
For example, a VIO of 1.65V - 3.6V allows for I/O at the 1.8V, 2.5V or 3V levels, driving and receiving signals to and from other 1.8V,
2.5V or 3V devices on the same data bus. VIO may be tied to VCC so that interface signals operate at the same voltage as the core
of the device. VIO is not available in all package options, when not available the VIO supply is tied to VCC internal to the package.
During the rise of power supplies the VIO supply voltage must remain less than or equal to the VCC supply voltage. This supply is not
available in all package options. For a backward compatible SO16 footprint, the VIO supply is tied to VCC inside the package; thus,
the IO will function at VCC level.
2.12 Supply and Signal Ground (V )
SS
VSS is the common voltage drain and ground reference for the device core, input signal receivers, and output drivers.
2.13 Not Connected (NC)
No device internal signal is connected to the package connector nor is there any future plan to use the connector for a signal. The
connection may safely be used for routing space for a signal on a Printed Circuit Board (PCB). However, any signal connected to an
NC must not have voltage levels higher than VIO.
2.14 Reserved for Future Use (RFU)
No device internal signal is currently connected to the package connector but is there potential future use of the connector. It is
recommended to not use RFU connectors for PCB routing channels so that the PCB may take advantage of future enhanced
features in compatible footprint devices.
2.15 Do Not Use (DNU)
A device internal signal may be connected to the package connector. The connection may be used by Cypress for test or other
purposes and is not intended for connection to any host system signal. Any DNU signal related function will be inactive when the
signal is at VIL. The signal has an internal pull-down resistor and may be left unconnected in the host system or may be tied to VSS
.
Do not use these connections for PCB signal routing channels. Do not connect any host system signal to these connections.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 11 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
2.16 Block Diagrams
Figure 2. Bus Master and Memory Devices on the SPI Bus - Single Bit Data Path
HOLD#
WP#
HOLD#
WP#
SI
SO
SI
SO
SCK
SCK
CS2#
CS2#
CS1#
CS1#
FL-S
Flash
FL-S
Flash
SPI
Bus Master
Figure 3. Bus Master and Memory Devices on the SPI Bus - Dual Bit Data Path
HOLD#
HOLD#
WP#
IO1
IO0
SCK
WP#
IO1
IO0
SCK
CS2#
CS2#
CS1#
CS1#
FL-S
Flash
FL-S
Flash
SPI
Bus Master
Figure 4. Bus Master and Memory Devices on the SPI Bus - Quad Bit Data Path
IO3
IO2
IO3
IO2
IO1
IO1
IO0
IO0
SCK
SCK
CS2#
CS2#
CS1#
CS1#
FL-S
Flash
FL-S
Flash
SPI
Bus Master
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 12 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3. Signal Protocols
3.1
SPI Clock Modes
3.1.1 Single Data Rate (SDR)
The S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices can be driven by an embedded microcontroller (bus master) in either of the two following
clocking modes.
Mode 0 with Clock Polarity (CPOL) = 0 and, Clock Phase (CPHA) = 0
Mode 3 with CPOL = 1 and, CPHA = 1
For these two modes, input data into the device is always latched in on the rising edge of the SCK signal and the output data is
always available from the falling edge of the SCK clock signal.
The difference between the two modes is the clock polarity when the bus master is in standby mode and not transferring any data.
SCK will stay at logic low state with CPOL = 0, CPHA = 0
SCK will stay at logic high state with CPOL = 1, CPHA = 1
Figure 5. SPI SDR Modes Supported
CPOL=0_CPHA=0_SCK
CPOL=1_CPHA=1_SCK
CS#
SI
MSB
SO
MSB
Timing diagrams throughout the remainder of the document are generally shown as both mode 0 and 3 by showing SCK as both
high and low at the fall of CS#. In some cases a timing diagram may show only mode 0 with SCK low at the fall of CS#. In such a
case, mode 3 timing simply means clock is high at the fall of CS# so no SCK rising edge set up or hold time to the falling edge of
CS# is needed for mode 3.
SCK cycles are measured (counted) from one falling edge of SCK to the next falling edge of SCK. In mode 0 the beginning of the
first SCK cycle in a command is measured from the falling edge of CS# to the first falling edge of SCK because SCK is already low
at the beginning of a command.
3.1.2 Double Data Rate (DDR)
Mode 0 and Mode 3 are also supported for DDR commands. In DDR commands, the instruction bits are always latched on the rising
edge of clock, the same as in SDR commands. However, the address and input data that follow the instruction are latched on both
the rising and falling edges of SCK. The first address bit is latched on the first rising edge of SCK following the falling edge at the end
of the last instruction bit. The first bit of output data is driven on the falling edge at the end of the last access latency (dummy) cycle.
SCK cycles are measured (counted) in the same way as in SDR commands, from one falling edge of SCK to the next falling edge of
SCK. In mode 0 the beginning of the first SCK cycle in a command is measured from the falling edge of CS# to the first falling edge
of SCK because SCK is already low at the beginning of a command.
Figure 6. SPI DDR Modes Supported
CPOL=0_CPHA=0_SCK
CPOL=1_CPHA=1_SCK
CS#
Instruction
Address
Mode
Dummy / DLP
Read Data
Transfer_Phase
SI
Inst. 7
Inst. 0
A31 A30
A0
M7
M6
M0
SO
DLP7
DLP0 D0
D1
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 13 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3.2
Command Protocol
All communication between the host system and S25FL128S and S25FL256S memory devices is in the form of units called
commands.
All commands begin with an instruction that selects the type of information transfer or device operation to be performed. Commands
may also have an address, instruction modifier, latency period, data transfer to the memory, or data transfer from the memory. All
instruction, address, and data information is transferred serially between the host system and memory device.
All instructions are transferred from host to memory as a single bit serial sequence on the SI signal.
Single bit wide commands may provide an address or data sent only on the SI signal. Data may be sent back to the host serially on
the SO signal.
Dual or Quad Output commands provide an address sent to the memory only on the SI signal. Data will be returned to the host as a
sequence of bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or four bit (nibble) groups on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3.
Dual or Quad Input/Output (I/O) commands provide an address sent from the host as bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or, four bit (nibble)
groups on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3. Data is returned to the host similarly as bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or, four bit (nibble) groups on IO0,
IO1, IO2, and IO3.
Commands are structured as follows:
Each command begins with CS# going low and ends with CS# returning high. The memory device is selected by the host driving
the Chip Select (CS#) signal low throughout a command.
The serial clock (SCK) marks the transfer of each bit or group of bits between the host and memory.
Each command begins with an eight bit (byte) instruction. The instruction is always presented only as a single bit serial sequence
on the Serial Input (SI) signal with one bit transferred to the memory device on each SCK rising edge. The instruction selects the
type of information transfer or device operation to be performed.
The instruction may be stand alone or may be followed by address bits to select a location within one of several address spaces
in the device. The instruction determines the address space used. The address may be either a 24-bit or a 32-bit byte boundary,
address. The address transfers occur on SCK rising edge, in SDR commands, or on every SCK edge, in DDR commands.
The width of all transfers following the instruction are determined by the instruction sent. Following transfers may continue to be
single bit serial on only the SI or Serial Output (SO) signals, they may be done in two bit groups per (dual) transfer on the IO0 and
IO1 signals, or they may be done in 4 bit groups per (quad) transfer on the IO0-IO3 signals. Within the dual or quad groups the
least significant bit is on IO0. More significant bits are placed in significance order on each higher numbered IO signal. SIngle bits
or parallel bit groups are transferred in most to least significant bit order.
Some instructions send an instruction modifier called mode bits, following the address, to indicate that the next command will be
of the same type with an implied, rather than an explicit, instruction. The next command thus does not provide an instruction byte,
only a new address and mode bits. This reduces the time needed to send each command when the same command type is
repeated in a sequence of commands. The mode bit transfers occur on SCK rising edge, in SDR commands, or on every SCK
edge, in DDR commands.
The address or mode bits may be followed by write data to be stored in the memory device or by a read latency period before
read data is returned to the host.
Write data bit transfers occur on SCK rising edge, in SDR commands, or on every SCK edge, in DDR commands.
SCK continues to toggle during any read access latency period. The latency may be zero to several SCK cycles (also referred to
as dummy cycles). At the end of the read latency cycles, the first read data bits are driven from the outputs on SCK falling edge at
the end of the last read latency cycle. The first read data bits are considered transferred to the host on the following SCK rising
edge. Each following transfer occurs on the next SCK rising edge, in SDR commands, or on every SCK edge, in DDR commands.
If the command returns read data to the host, the device continues sending data transfers until the host takes the CS# signal high.
The CS# signal can be driven high after any transfer in the read data sequence. This will terminate the command.
At the end of a command that does not return data, the host drives the CS# input high. The CS# signal must go high after the
eighth bit, of a stand alone instruction or, of the last write data byte that is transferred. That is, the CS# signal must be driven high
when the number of clock cycles after CS# signal was driven low is an exact multiple of eight cycles. If the CS# signal does not go
high exactly at the eight SCK cycle boundary of the instruction or write data, the command is rejected and not executed.
All instruction, address, and mode bits are shifted into the device with the Most Significant Bits (MSB) first. The data bits are
shifted in and out of the device MSB first. All data is transferred in byte units with the lowest address byte sent first. Following
bytes of data are sent in lowest to highest byte address order i.e. the byte address increments.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 14 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
All attempts to read the flash memory array during a program, erase, or a write cycle (embedded operations) are ignored. The
embedded operation will continue to execute without any affect. A very limited set of commands are accepted during an
embedded operation. These are discussed in the individual command descriptions.
Depending on the command, the time for execution varies. A command to read status information from an executing command is
available to determine when the command completes execution and whether the command was successful.
3.2.1 Command Sequence Examples
Figure 7. Stand Alone Instruction Command
CS#
SCK
SI
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Phase
Instruction
Figure 8. Single Bit Wide Input Command
CS#
SCK
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
Phase
Instruction
Input Data
Figure 9. Single Bit Wide Output Command
CS#
SCK
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Phase
Instruction
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 10. Single Bit Wide I/O Command without Latency
CS#
SCK
SI
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 31
1 0
SO
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Data 1 Data 2
Phase
Instruction
Address
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 15 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 11. Single Bit Wide I/O Command with Latency
CS#
SCK
SI
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 31
1 0
SO
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Data 1
Phase
Instruction
Address
Dummy Cycles
Figure 12. Dual Output Command
CS#
SCK
IO0
IO1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 31 30 29 0
6 4 2 0 6 4 2 0
7 5 3 1 7 5 3 1
Phase
Instruction
Address
6 Dummy
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 13. Quad Output Command without Latency
CS#
SCK
IO0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 31
1
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
IO1
5
6
7
IO2
IO3
Phase
Instruction
Address
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4 Data 5 ...
Figure 14. Dual I/O Command
CS#
SCK
IO0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 30
31
2 0
3 1
6 4 2 0 6 4 2
7 5 3 1 7 5 3
0
1
IO1
Phase
Instruction
Address
Dummy
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 15. Quad I/O Command
CS#
SCK
IO0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 28
4 0 4
5 1 5
4 0 4 0 4 0 4 0
5 1 5 1 5 1 5 1
6 2 6 2 6 2 6 2
7 3 7 3 7 3 7 3
D1 D2 D3 D4
IO1
29
IO2
30
6 2 6
IO3
31
7 3 7
Phase
Instruction
Address Mode Dummy
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 16 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 16. DDR Fast Read with EHPLC = 00b
CS#
SCK
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 3130 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
SO
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Dummy Data 1 Data 2
Phase
Instruction
Addess
Mode
Figure 17. DDR Dual I/O Read with EHPLC = 01b and DLP
CS#
SCK
IO0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
30 28
31 29
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
7 6 5 4
7 6 5 4
3
3
2
2
1 0
1 0
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
IO1
Phase
Instruction
Address
Mode
Dum
DLP
Data 1
Figure 18. DDR Quad I/O Read
CS#
SCK
IO0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
2824201612 8
2925211713 9
4
5
0 4
1 5
0
1
7 6
5
5
5
5
4 3
4 3
4 3
4 3
DLP
2
2
2
2
1 0
1 0
1 0
1 0
4
5
6
7
0 4
1 5
0
IO1
7 6
7 6
7 6
1
2
3
IO2
302622181410 6 2 6
312723191511 7 3 7
2
2 6
3 7
IO3
3
Phase
Instruction
Address
Dummy
D1 D2
Mode
Additional sequence diagrams, specific to each command, are provided in Section 9. Commands on page 64.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 17 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3.3
Interface States
This section describes the input and output signal levels as related to the SPI interface behavior.
Table 3. Interface States Summary
Interface State
Power-Off
V
V
RESET#
SCK
CS# HOLD# / IO3 WP# / IO2 SO / IO1 SI / IO0
CC
IO
< V (low)
V
X
X
X
X
X
Z
X
CC
CC
CC
Low Power
< V (cut-off)
V
X
X
X
X
X
Z
X
CC
Hardware Data Protection
Power-On (Cold) Reset
Hardware (Warm) Reset
Interface Standby
Instruction Cycle
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Z
Z
Z
Z
X
X
X
CC
IO
CC
CC
CC
CC
CC
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
HL
HH
HH
HH
X
X
CC
IO
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
HH
HL
HL
X
X
X
CC
IO
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
HT
HH
HL
HV
X
HV
X
CC
IO
Hold Cycle
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
HV or HT
CC
IO
Single Input Cycle
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HH
HH
HT
HT
HT
HL
HL
HL
HH
HH
HH
X
X
X
Z
Z
HV
X
CC
Host to Memory Transfer
≤ V
CC
≥ V (min)
IO
Single Latency (Dummy) Cycle
≥ V (min)
CC
≤ V
CC
Single Output Cycle
Memory to Host Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≤ V
CC
≥ V (min)
MV
X
CC
Dual Input Cycle
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HH
HH
HT
HT
HT
HL
HL
HL
HH
HH
HH
X
X
X
HV
X
HV
X
CC
Host to Memory Transfer
≤ V
CC
Dual Latency (Dummy) Cycle
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
IO CC
CC
Dual Output Cycle
Memory to Host Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≤ V
CC
≥ V (min)
MV
MV
CC
QPP Address Input Cycle
Host to Memory Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HT
HL
X
X
X
HV
CC
≤ V
CC
Quad Input Cycle
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HH
HH
HT
HT
HT
HL
HL
HL
HV
X
HV
X
HV
X
HV
X
CC
Host to Memory Transfer
≤ V
CC
Quad Latency (Dummy) Cycle
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
IO CC
CC
Quad Output Cycle
Memory to Host Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≤ V
CC
≥ V (min)
MV
MV
MV
MV
CC
DDR Single Input Cycle
Host to Memory Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HH
HT
HT
HL
HL
X
X
X
X
X
HV
HV
HV
CC
≤ V
CC
DDR Dual Input Cycle
Host to Memory Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≤ V
CC
≥ V (min)
HV
HV
CC
DDR Quad Input Cycle
Host to Memory Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HH
HH
HT
HT
HT
HL
HL
HL
HV
MV or Z
Z
HV
MV or Z
Z
CC
≤ V
CC
DDR Latency (Dummy) Cycle
≥ V (min)
≥ V (min) ≤ V
MV or Z MV or Z
CC
IO
CC
DDR Single Output Cycle
Memory to Host Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
MV
MV
MV
X
CC
≤ V
CC
DDR Dual Output Cycle
Memory to Host Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
HH
HH
HT
HT
HL
HL
Z
Z
MV
MV
CC
≤ V
CC
DDR Quad Output Cycle
Memory to Host Transfer
≥ V (min)
IO
≥ V (min)
MV
MV
CC
≤ V
CC
Legend
Z = No driver - floating signal
HL = Host driving V
IL
HH = Host driving V
IH
HV = Either HL or HH
X = HL or HH or Z
HT = Toggling between HL and HH
ML = Memory driving V
IL
MH = Memory driving V
MV = Either ML or MH
IH
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 18 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3.3.1 Power-Off
When the core supply voltage is at or below the VCC (low) voltage, the device is considered to be powered off. The device does not
react to external signals, and is prevented from performing any program or erase operation.
3.3.2 Low Power Hardware Data Protection
When VCC is less than VCC (cut-off) the memory device will ignore commands to ensure that program and erase operations can not
start when the core supply voltage is out of the operating range.
3.3.3 Power-On (Cold) Reset
When the core voltage supply remains at or below the VCC (low) voltage for tPD time, then rises to VCC (Minimum) the device will
begin its Power-On Reset (POR) process. POR continues until the end of tPU. During tPU the device does not react to external input
signals nor drive any outputs. Following the end of tPU the device transitions to the Interface Standby state and can accept
commands. For additional information on POR see Section 5.3.1 Power-On (Cold) Reset on page 29.
3.3.4 Hardware (Warm) Reset
Some of the device package options provide a RESET# input. When RESET# is driven low for tRP time the device starts the
hardware reset process. The process continues for tRPH time. Following the end of both tRPH and the reset hold time following the
rise of RESET# (tRH) the device transitions to the Interface Standby state and can accept commands. For additional information on
hardware reset see Section 28 POR followed by Hardware Reset on page 29.
3.3.5 Interface Standby
When CS# is high the SPI interface is in standby state. Inputs other than RESET# are ignored. The interface waits for the beginning
of a new command. The next interface state is Instruction Cycle when CS# goes low to begin a new command.
While in interface standby state the memory device draws standby current (ISB) if no embedded algorithm is in progress. If an
embedded algorithm is in progress, the related current is drawn until the end of the algorithm when the entire device returns to
standby current draw.
3.3.6 Instruction Cycle
When the host drives the MSB of an instruction and CS# goes low, on the next rising edge of SCK the device captures the MSB of
the instruction that begins the new command. On each following rising edge of SCK the device captures the next lower significance
bit of the 8-bit instruction. The host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, HOLD# high, and drives Write Protect (WP#) signal as needed for
the instruction. However, WP# is only relevant during instruction cycles of a WRR command and is otherwise ignored.
Each instruction selects the address space that is operated on and the transfer format used during the remainder of the command.
The transfer format may be Single, Dual output, Quad output, Dual I/O, Quad I/O, DDR Single I/O, DDR Dual I/O, or DDR Quad I/O.
The expected next interface state depends on the instruction received.
Some commands are stand alone, needing no address or data transfer to or from the memory. The host returns CS# high after the
rising edge of SCK for the eighth bit of the instruction in such commands. The next interface state in this case is Interface Standby.
3.3.7 Hold
When Quad mode is not enabled (CR[1]=0) the HOLD# / IO3 signal is used as the HOLD# input. The host keeps RESET# high,
HOLD# low, SCK may be at a valid level or continue toggling, and CS# is low. When HOLD# is low a command is paused, as though
SCK were held low. SI / IO0 and SO / IO1 ignore the input level when acting as inputs and are high impedance when acting as
outputs during hold state. Whether these signals are input or output depends on the command and the point in the command
sequence when HOLD# is asserted low.
When HOLD# returns high the next state is the same state the interface was in just before HOLD# was asserted low.
When Quad mode is enabled the HOLD# / IO3 signal is used as IO3.
During DDR commands the HOLD# and WP# inputs are ignored.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 19 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3.3.8 Single Input Cycle - Host to Memory Transfer
Several commands transfer information after the instruction on the single serial input (SI) signal from host to the memory device. The
dual output, and quad output commands send address to the memory using only SI but return read data using the I/O signals. The
host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, HOLD# high, and drives SI as needed for the command. The memory does not drive the Serial
Output (SO) signal.
The expected next interface state depends on the instruction. Some instructions continue sending address or data to the memory
using additional Single Input Cycles. Others may transition to Single Latency, or directly to Single, Dual, or Quad Output.
3.3.9 Single Latency (Dummy) Cycle
Read commands may have zero to several latency cycles during which read data is read from the main flash memory array before
transfer to the host. The number of latency cycles are determined by the Latency Code in the configuration register (CR[7:6]). During
the latency cycles, the host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, and HOLD# high. The Write Protect (WP#) signal is ignored. The host
may drive the SI signal during these cycles or the host may leave SI floating. The memory does not use any data driven on SI / I/O0
or other I/O signals during the latency cycles. In dual or quad read commands, the host must stop driving the I/O signals on the
falling edge at the end of the last latency cycle. It is recommended that the host stop driving I/O signals during latency cycles so that
there is sufficient time for the host drivers to turn off before the memory begins to drive at the end of the latency cycles. This prevents
driver conflict between host and memory when the signal direction changes. The memory does not drive the Serial Output (SO) or I/
O signals during the latency cycles.
The next interface state depends on the command structure i.e. the number of latency cycles, and whether the read is single, dual,
or quad width.
3.3.10 Single Output Cycle - Memory to Host Transfer
Several commands transfer information back to the host on the single Serial Output (SO) signal. The host keeps RESET# high, CS#
low, and HOLD# high. The Write Protect (WP#) signal is ignored. The memory ignores the Serial Input (SI) signal. The memory
drives SO with data.
The next interface state continues to be Single Output Cycle until the host returns CS# to high ending the command.
3.3.11 Dual Input Cycle - Host to Memory Transfer
The Read Dual I/O command transfers two address or mode bits to the memory in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, CS#
low, HOLD# high. The Write Protect (WP#) signal is ignored. The host drives address on SI / IO0 and SO / IO1.
The next interface state following the delivery of address and mode bits is a Dual Latency Cycle if there are latency cycles needed or
Dual Output Cycle if no latency is required.
3.3.12 Dual Latency (Dummy) Cycle
Read commands may have zero to several latency cycles during which read data is read from the main flash memory array before
transfer to the host. The number of latency cycles are determined by the Latency Code in the configuration register (CR[7:6]). During
the latency cycles, the host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, and HOLD# high. The Write Protect (WP#) signal is ignored. The host
may drive the SI / IO0 and SO / IO1 signals during these cycles or the host may leave SI / IO0 and SO / IO1 floating. The memory
does not use any data driven on SI / IO0 and SO / IO1 during the latency cycles. The host must stop driving SI / IO0 and SO / IO1
on the falling edge at the end of the last latency cycle. It is recommended that the host stop driving them during all latency cycles so
that there is sufficient time for the host drivers to turn off before the memory begins to drive at the end of the latency cycles. This
prevents driver conflict between host and memory when the signal direction changes. The memory does not drive the SI / IO0 and
SO / IO1 signals during the latency cycles.
The next interface state following the last latency cycle is a Dual Output Cycle.
3.3.13 Dual Output Cycle - Memory to Host Transfer
The Read Dual Output and Read Dual I/O return data to the host two bits in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, and
HOLD# high. The Write Protect (WP#) signal is ignored. The memory drives data on the SI / IO0 and SO / IO1 signals during the
dual output cycles.
The next interface state continues to be Dual Output Cycle until the host returns CS# to high ending the command.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 20 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3.3.14 QPP or QOR Address Input Cycle
The Quad Page Program and Quad Output Read commands send address to the memory only on IO0. The other IO signals are
ignored because the device must be in Quad mode for these commands thus the Hold and Write Protect features are not active. The
host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, and drives IO0.
For QPP the next interface state following the delivery of address is the Quad Input Cycle.
For QOR the next interface state following address is a Quad Latency Cycle if there are latency cycles needed or Quad Output
Cycle if no latency is required.
3.3.15 Quad Input Cycle - Host to Memory Transfer
The Quad I/O Read command transfers four address or mode bits to the memory in each cycle. The Quad Page Program command
transfers four data bits to the memory in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, CS# low, and drives the IO signals.
For Quad I/O Read the next interface state following the delivery of address and mode bits is a Quad Latency Cycle if there are
latency cycles needed or Quad Output Cycle if no latency is required. For Quad Page Program the host returns CS# high following
the delivery of data to be programmed and the interface returns to standby state.
3.3.16 Quad Latency (Dummy) Cycle
Read commands may have zero to several latency cycles during which read data is read from the main flash memory array before
transfer to the host. The number of latency cycles are determined by the Latency Code in the configuration register (CR[7:6]). During
the latency cycles, the host keeps RESET# high, CS# low. The host may drive the IO signals during these cycles or the host may
leave the IO floating. The memory does not use any data driven on IO during the latency cycles. The host must stop driving the IO
signals on the falling edge at the end of the last latency cycle. It is recommended that the host stop driving them during all latency
cycles so that there is sufficient time for the host drivers to turn off before the memory begins to drive at the end of the latency
cycles. This prevents driver conflict between host and memory when the signal direction changes. The memory does not drive the IO
signals during the latency cycles.
The next interface state following the last latency cycle is a Quad Output Cycle.
3.3.17 Quad Output Cycle - Memory to Host Transfer
The Quad Output Read and Quad I/O Read return data to the host four bits in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS#
low. The memory drives data on IO0-IO3 signals during the Quad output cycles.
The next interface state continues to be Quad Output Cycle until the host returns CS# to high ending the command.
3.3.18 DDR Single Input Cycle - Host to Memory Transfer
The DDR Fast Read command sends address, and mode bits to the memory only on the IO0 signal. One bit is transferred on the
rising edge of SCK and one bit on the falling edge in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS# low. The other IO signals
are ignored by the memory.
The next interface state following the delivery of address and mode bits is a DDR Latency Cycle.
3.3.19 DDR Dual Input Cycle - Host to Memory Transfer
The DDR Dual I/O Read command sends address, and mode bits to the memory only on the IO0 and IO1 signals. Two bits are
transferred on the rising edge of SCK and two bits on the falling edge in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS# low.
The IO2 and IO3 signals are ignored by the memory.
The next interface state following the delivery of address and mode bits is a DDR Latency Cycle.
3.3.20 DDR Quad Input Cycle - Host to Memory Transfer
The DDR Quad I/O Read command sends address, and mode bits to the memory on all the IO signals. Four bits are transferred on
the rising edge of SCK and four bits on the falling edge in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS# low.
The next interface state following the delivery of address and mode bits is a DDR Latency Cycle.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 21 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
3.3.21 DDR Latency Cycle
DDR Read commands may have one to several latency cycles during which read data is read from the main flash memory array
before transfer to the host. The number of latency cycles are determined by the Latency Code in the configuration register (CR[7:6]).
During the latency cycles, the host keeps RESET# high and CS# low. The host may not drive the IO signals during these cycles. So
that there is sufficient time for the host drivers to turn off before the memory begins to drive. This prevents driver conflict between
host and memory when the signal direction changes. The memory has an option to drive all the IO signals with a Data Learning
Pattern (DLP) during the last 4 latency cycles. The DLP option should not be enabled when there are fewer than five latency cycles
so that there is at least one cycle of high impedance for turn around of the IO signals before the memory begins driving the DLP.
When there are more than 4 cycles of latency the memory does not drive the IO signals until the last four cycles of latency.
The next interface state following the last latency cycle is a DDR Single, Dual, or Quad Output Cycle, depending on the instruction.
3.3.22 DDR Single Output Cycle - Memory to Host Transfer
The DDR Fast Read command returns bits to the host only on the SO / IO1 signal. One bit is transferred on the rising edge of SCK
and one bit on the falling edge in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS# low. The other IO signals are not driven by the
memory.
The next interface state continues to be DDR Single Output Cycle until the host returns CS# to high ending the command.
3.3.23 DDR Dual Output Cycle - Memory to Host Transfer
The DDR Dual I/O Read command returns bits to the host only on the IO0 and IO1 signals. Two bits are transferred on the rising
edge of SCK and two bits on the falling edge in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS# low. The IO2 and IO3 signals
are not driven by the memory.
The next interface state continues to be DDR Dual Output Cycle until the host returns CS# to high ending the command.
3.3.24 DDR Quad Output Cycle - Memory to Host Transfer
The DDR Quad I/O Read command returns bits to the host on all the IO signals. Four bits are transferred on the rising edge of SCK
and four bits on the falling edge in each cycle. The host keeps RESET# high, and CS# low.
The next interface state continues to be DDR Quad Output Cycle until the host returns CS# to high ending the command.
3.4
Configuration Register Effects on the Interface
The configuration register bits 7 and 6 (CR1[7:6]) select the latency code for all read commands. The latency code selects the
number of mode bit and latency cycles for each type of instruction.
The configuration register bit 1 (CR1[1]) selects whether Quad mode is enabled to ignore HOLD# and WP# and allow Quad Page
Program, Quad Output Read, and Quad I/O Read commands. Quad mode must also be selected to allow Read DDR Quad I/O
commands.
3.5
Data Protection
Some basic protection against unintended changes to stored data are provided and controlled purely by the hardware design. These
are described below. Other software managed protection methods are discussed in the Software Interface on page 44 section of this
document.
3.5.1 Power-Up
When the core supply voltage is at or below the VCC (low) voltage, the device is considered to be powered off. The device does not
react to external signals, and is prevented from performing any program or erase operation. Program and erase operations continue
to be prevented during the Power-on Reset (POR) because no command is accepted until the exit from POR to the Interface
Standby state.
3.5.2 Low Power
When VCC is less than VCC (cut-off) the memory device will ignore commands to ensure that program and erase operations can not
start when the core supply voltage is out of the operating range.
3.5.3 Clock Pulse Count
The device verifies that all program, erase, and Write Registers (WRR) commands consist of a clock pulse count that is a multiple of
eight before executing them. A command not having a multiple of 8 clock pulse count is ignored and no error status is set for the
command.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 22 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
4. Electrical Specifications
4.1
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 4. Absolute Maximum Ratings
Storage Temperature Plastic Packages
–65°C to +150°C
–65°C to +125°C
–0.5V to +4.0V
–0.5V to +4.0V
–0.5V to +(VIO + 0.5V)
100 mA
Ambient Temperature with Power Applied
VCC
VIO (Note 1)
Input voltage with respect to Ground (VSS) (Note 2)
Output Short Circuit Current (Note 3)
Notes:
1.
V
must always be less than or equal V + 200 mV.
IO CC
2. See Section 4.3.3 Input Signal Overshoot on page 24 for allowed maximums during signal transition.
3. No more than one output may be shorted to ground at a time. Duration of the short circuit should not be greater than one second.
4. Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the
device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational sections of this data sheet is not implied. Exposure of the device to absolute maximum
rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
4.2
Thermal Resistance
Table 5. Thermal Resistance
Parameter Description
WNG008
SO316
FAB024
FAC024
Unit
Thermal resistance
(junction to ambient)
Theta JA
28
38
36
36.5
°C/W
4.3
Operating Ranges
Operating ranges define those limits between which the functionality of the device is guaranteed.
4.3.1 Power Supply Voltages
Some package options provide access to a separate input and output buffer power supply called VIO. Packages which do not
provide the separate VIO connection, internally connect the device VIO to VCC. For these packages the references to VIO are then
also references to VCC
.
VCC
VIO
2.7V to 3.6V
1.65V to VCC +200 mV
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 23 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
4.3.2 Temperature Ranges
Spec
Unit
Parameter
Symbol
Device
Min
–40
–40
–40
–40
–40
–40
Max
+85
Industrial (I)
Industrial Plus (V)
+105
+125
+85
Extended (N)
Ambient Temperature
TA
°C
Automotive, AEC-Q100 Grade 3 (A)
Automotive, AEC-Q100 Grade 2 (B)
Automotive AEC-Q100 Grade 1 (M)
+105
+125
Note:
1. Industrial Plus operating and performance parameters will be determined by device characterization and may vary from standard industrial temperature range devices
as currently shown in this specification.
4.3.3 Input Signal Overshoot
During DC conditions, input or I/O signals should remain equal to or between VSS and VIO. During voltage transitions, inputs or I/Os
may overshoot VSS to –2.0V or overshoot to VIO +2.0V, for periods up to 20 ns.
Figure 19. Maximum Negative Overshoot Waveform
20 ns
20 ns
VIL
- 2.0V
20 ns
Figure 20. Maximum Positive Overshoot Waveform
20 ns
VIO + 2.0V
VIH
20 ns
20 ns
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 24 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
4.4
Power-Up and Power-Down
The device must not be selected at power-up or power-down (that is, CS# must follow the voltage applied on VCC) until VCC reaches
the correct value as follows:
VCC (min) at power-up, and then for a further delay of tPU
VSS at power-down
A simple pull-up resistor (generally of the order of 100 k) on Chip Select (CS#) can usually be used to insure safe and proper
power-up and power-down.
The device ignores all instructions until a time delay of tPU has elapsed after the moment that VCC rises above the minimum VCC
threshold. See Figure 21. However, correct operation of the device is not guaranteed if VCC returns below VCC (min) during tPU. No
command should be sent to the device until the end of tPU
.
After power-up (tPU), the device is in Standby mode (not Deep Power Down mode), draws CMOS standby current (ISB), and the
WEL bit is reset.
During power-down or voltage drops below VCC (cut-off), the voltage must drop below VCC (low) for a period of tPD for the part to
initialize correctly on power-up. See Figure 22. If during a voltage drop the VCC stays above VCC (cut-off) the part will stay initialized
and will work correctly when VCC is again above VCC (min). In the event Power-on Reset (POR) did not complete correctly after
power up, the assertion of the RESET# signal or receiving a software reset command (RESET) will restart the POR process.
Normal precautions must be taken for supply rail decoupling to stabilize the VCC supply at the device. Each device in a system
should have the VCC rail decoupled by a suitable capacitor close to the package supply connection (this capacitor is generally of the
order of 0.1 µf).
Table 6. Power-Up / Power-Down Voltage and Timing
Symbol
VCC (min)
Parameter
VCC (Minimum Operation Voltage)
Min
2.7
2.4
Max
–
Unit
V
VCC (cut-off)
VCC (Cut 0ff Where Re-initialization is Needed)
–
V
VCC (Low Voltage for Initialization to Occur)
VCC (Low Voltage for Initialization to Occur at Embedded)
1.6
2.3
VCC (low)
–
V
tPU
tPD
VCC (min) to Read Operation
VCC (low) Time
–
300
–
µs
µs
15.0
Figure 21. Power-Up
VCC
(max)
VCC
(min)
VCC
tPU
Full Device Access
Time
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 25 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 22. Power-Down and Voltage Drop
VCC
(max)
VCC
No Device Access Allowed
(min)
VCC
tPU
Device Access
Allowed
(cut-off)
VCC
(low)
VCC
tPD
Time
4.5
DC Characteristics
Applicable within operating ranges.
Table 7. DC Characteristics — Operating Temperature Range –40°C to +85°C
Symbol
Parameter
Input Low Voltage
Input High Voltage
Output Low Voltage
Output High Voltage
Test Conditions
Min
Typ (1)
Max
Unit
V
V
V
–0.5
0.7 V
–
–
–
–
–
–
0.2 x V
IL
IO
V +0.4
IO
V
IH
IO
V
V
I
I
= 1.6 mA, V = V min
0.15 V
IO
V
OL
OL
CC
CC
= –0.1 mA
0.85 V
IO
V
OH
OH
I
Input Leakage Current V = V Max, V = V or V
–
±2
±2
µA
LI
CC
CC
IN
IH
IL
Output Leakage
Current
I
V
= V Max, V = V or V
–
–
µA
LO
CC
CC
IN
IH
IL
Serial SDR@50 MHz
Serial SDR@133 MHz
Quad SDR@80 MHz
Quad SDR@104 MHz
Quad DDR@66 MHz
Quad DDR@80 MHz
16
33
50
61
75
90
Active Power Supply
Current (READ)
I
–
–
mA
CC1
Outputs unconnected during read data return (2)
Active Power Supply
Current (Page
Program)
I
CS# = V
–
–
100
mA
CC2
IO
Active Power Supply
Current (WRR)
I
I
I
CS# = V
CS# = V
CS# = V
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
100
100
100
100
300
mA
mA
mA
µA
CC3
CC4
CC5
IO
IO
IO
Active Power Supply
Current (SE)
Active Power Supply
Current (BE)
–
RESET#, CS# = V ; SI, SCK = V or V
Industrial Temp
,
,
IO
IO
SS
I
(Industrial)
Standby Current
70
70
SB
RESET#, CS# = V ; SI, SCK = V or V
Industrial Plus Temp
IO
IO
SS
I
(Industrial Plus) Standby Current
µA
SB
Notes:
1. Typical values are at T = 25°C and V = V = 3V.
AI
CC
IO
2. Output switching current is not included.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 26 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 8. DC Characteristics — Operating Temperature Range -40°C to +105°C and -40°C to +125°C
Symbol
VIL
Parameter
Input Low Voltage
Input High Voltage
Test Conditions
Min
–0.5
Typ (1)
Max
Unit
V
0.2 x VIO
VIO+0.4
0.15 x VIO
VIH
0.7 VIO
V
VOL
Output Low Voltage IOL = 1.6 mA, VCC = VCC min
Output High Voltage IOH = –0.1 mA
V
VOH
0.85 VIO
V
Input Leakage
ILI
VCC = VCC Max, VIN = VIH or VIL
Current
±2
±2
µA
µA
Output Leakage
ILO
VCC = VCC Max, VIN = VIH or VIL
Current
Serial SDR@50 MHz
Serial SDR@133 MHz
Quad SDR@80 MHz
22
35
50
61
75
90
Active Power Supply Quad SDR@104 MHz
ICC1
mA
Current (READ)
Quad DDR@66 MHz
Quad DDR@80 MHz
Outputs unconnected during read data
return (2)
Active Power Supply
Current (Page
Program)
ICC2
CS# = VIO
100
mA
Active Power Supply
Current (WRR)
ICC3
ICC4
CS# = VIO
CS# = VIO
100
100
100
100
300
mA
mA
mA
µA
Active Power Supply
Current (SE)
Active Power Supply
Current (BE)
ICC5
CS# = VIO
RESET#, CS# = VIO; SI, SCK = VIO or
I
SB (Industrial)
Standby Current
70
70
VSS, Industrial Temp
RESET#, CS# = VIO; SI, SCK = VIO or
VSS, Industrial Plus Temp
ISB (Industrial Plus) Standby Current
µA
Notes:
1. Typical values are at T = 25°C and V = V = 3V.
AI
CC
IO
2. Output switching current is not included.
4.5.1 Active Power and Standby Power Modes
The device is enabled and in the Active Power mode when Chip Select (CS#) is Low. When CS# is high, the device is disabled, but
may still be in an Active Power mode until all program, erase, and write operations have completed. The device then goes into the
Standby Power mode, and power consumption drops to ISB
.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 27 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5. Timing Specifications
5.1
Key to Switching Waveforms
Figure 23. Waveform Element Meanings
Input
Symbol
Output
Valid at logic high or low
High Impedance
Any change permitted
Logic high Logic low
Valid at logic high or low
High Impedance Changing, state unknown Logic high Logic low
Figure 24. Input, Output, and Timing Reference Levels
Input Levels
Output Levels
0.85 x VIO
VIO + 0.4V
0.7 x VIO
Timing Reference Level
0.5 x VIO
0.2 x VIO
- 0.5V
0.15 x VIO
5.2
AC Test Conditions
Figure 25. Test Setup
Device
Under
Test
C
L
Table 9. AC Measurement Conditions
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Unit
30
CL
Load Capacitance
pF
15 (4)
Input Rise and Fall Times
Input Pulse Voltage
2.4
ns
V
0.2 x VIO to 0.8 VIO
0.5 VIO
Input Timing Ref Voltage
Output Timing Ref Voltage
V
0.5 VIO
V
Notes:
1. Output High-Z is defined as the point where data is no longer driven.
2. Input slew rate: 1.5 V/ns.
3. AC characteristics tables assume clock and data signals have the same slew rate (slope).
4. DDR Operation.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 28 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5.2.1 Capacitance Characteristics
Table 10. Capacitance
Parameter
Test Conditions
1 MHz
Min
Max
8
Unit
pF
CIN
Input Capacitance (applies to SCK, CS#, RESET#)
Output Capacitance (applies to All I/O)
COUT
1 MHz
8
pF
Note:
1. For more information on capacitance, please consult the IBIS models.
5.3
Reset
5.3.1 Power-On (Cold) Reset
The device executes a Power-On Reset (POR) process until a time delay of tPU has elapsed after the moment that VCC rises above
the minimum VCC threshold. See Figure 21 on page 25, Table 6 on page 25, and Table 11 on page 30. The device must not be
selected (CS# to go high with VIO) during power-up (tPU), i.e. no commands may be sent to the device until the end of tPU. RESET#
is ignored during POR. If RESET# is low during POR and remains low through and beyond the end of tPU, CS# must remain high
until tRH after RESET# returns high. RESET# must return high for greater than tRS before returning low to initiate a hardware reset.
Figure 26. Reset Low at the End of POR
VCC
VIO
tPU
RESET#
If RESET# is low at tPU end
tRH
CS#
CS# must be high at tPU end
Figure 27. Reset High at the End of POR
VCC
VIO
tPU
tPU
RESET#
CS#
If RESET# is high at tPU end
CS# may stay high or go low at tPU end
Figure 28. POR followed by Hardware Reset
VCC
VIO
tPU
tPU
tRS
RESET#
CS#
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 29 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5.3.2 Hardware (Warm) Reset
When the RESET# input transitions from VIH to VIL the device will reset register states in the same manner as power-on reset but,
does not go through the full reset process that is performed during POR. The hardware reset process requires a period of tRPH to
complete. If the POR process did not complete correctly for any reason during power-up (tPU), RESET# going low will initiate the full
POR process instead of the hardware reset process and will require tPU to complete the POR process.
The RESET# input provides a hardware method of resetting the flash memory device to standby state.
RESET# must be high for tRS following tPU or tRPH, before going low again to initiate a hardware reset.
When RESET# is driven low for at least a minimum period of time (tRP), the device terminates any operation in progress, tri-states
all outputs, and ignores all read/write commands for the duration of tRPH. The device resets the interface to standby state.
If CS# is low at the time RESET# is asserted, CS# must return high during tRPH before it can be asserted low again after tRH
.
Hardware Reset is only offered in 16-lead SOIC and BGA packages.
Figure 29. Hardware Reset
tRP
RESET#
CS#
Any prior reset
tRPH
tRH
tRH
tRS
tRPH
Table 11. Hardware Reset Parameters
Parameter
Description
Limit
Time
Unit
Reset Setup —
tRS
Min
50
ns
Prior Reset end and RESET# high before RESET# low
Reset Pulse Hold - RESET# low to CS# low
RESET# Pulse Width
tRPH
tRP
Min
Min
Min
35
200
50
µs
ns
ns
tRH
Reset Hold - RESET# high before CS# low
Notes:
1. RESET# Low is optional and ignored during Power-up (t ). If Reset# is asserted during the end of t , the device will remain in the reset state and t will determine
PU
PU
RH
when CS# may go Low.
2. Sum of t and t must be equal to or greater than t
RPH.
RP
RH
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 30 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5.4
SDR AC Characteristics
Table 12. AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO = VCC 2.7V to 3.6V)
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
SCK Clock Frequency for READ and 4READ
instructions
FSCK, R
DC
50
MHz
SCK Clock Frequency for single commands as
shown in Table 45 on page 67 (4)
FSCK, C
DC
DC
DC
133
104
MHz
MHz
MHz
SCK Clock Frequency for the following dual and
quad commands: DOR, 4DOR, QOR, 4QOR,
DIOR, 4DIOR, QIOR, 4QIOR
FSCK, C
SCK Clock Frequency for the QPP, 4QPP
commands
FSCK, QPP
80
PSCK
SCK Clock Period
Clock High Time (5)
Clock Low Time (5)
1/ FSCK
45% PSCK
45% PSCK
0.1
tWH, tCH
tWL, tCL
ns
ns
tCRT, tCLCH Clock Rise Time (slew rate)
tCFT, tCHCL Clock Fall Time (slew rate)
V/ns
V/ns
0.1
CS# High Time (Read Instructions)
tCS
10
50
ns
CS# High Time (Program/Erase)
tCSS
tCSH
tSU
CS# Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
CS# Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
Data in Setup Time
3
3
ns
ns
ns
ns
3000 (6)
1.5
2
tHD
Data in Hold Time
8.0 (2)
7.65 (3)
6.5 (4)
tV
Clock Low to Output Valid
ns
tHO
tDIS
Output Hold Time
2
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Output Disable Time
0
8
tWPS
tWPH
tHLCH
tCHHH
tHHCH
tCHHL
tHZ
WP# Setup Time
20 (1)
WP# Hold Time
100 (1)
HOLD# Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# Non Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# Non Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# enable to Output Invalid
HOLD# disable to Output Valid
3
3
3
3
8
8
tLZ
Notes:
1. Only applicable as a constraint for WRR instruction when SRWD is set to a 1.
2. Full V range (2.7 - 3.6V) and CL = 30 pF.
CC
3. Regulated V range (3.0 - 3.6V) and CL = 30 pF.
CC
4. Regulated V range (3.0 - 3.6V) and CL = 15 pF.
CC
5. ±10% duty cycle is supported for frequencies 50 MHz.
6. Maximum value only applies during Program/Erase Suspend/Resume commands.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 31 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 13. AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO 1.65V to 2.7V, VCC 2.7V to 3.6V)
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
MHz
MHz
SCK Clock Frequency for READ, 4READ
instructions
SCK Clock Frequency for all others (3)
FSCK, R
DC
50
FSCK, C
PSCK
tWH, tCH
tWL, tCL
DC
1/ FSCK
45% PSCK
45% PSCK
0.1
66
SCK Clock Period
Clock High Time (4)
ns
ns
Clock Low Time (4)
tCRT, tCLCH Clock Rise Time (slew rate)
tCFT, tCHCL Clock Fall Time (slew rate)
V/ns
V/ns
0.1
CS# High Time (Read Instructions)
tCS
10
50
ns
CS# High Time (Program/Erase)
tCSS
tCSH
tSU
CS# Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
CS# Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
Data in Setup Time
10
3
ns
ns
ns
ns
3000 (5)
5
tHD
Data in Hold Time
4
14.5 (2)
12.0 (3)
tV
Clock Low to Output Valid
ns
tHO
tDIS
Output Hold Time
2
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Output Disable Time
0
14
tWPS
tWPH
tHLCH
tCHHH
tHHCH
tCHHL
tHZ
WP# Setup Time
20 (1)
WP# Hold Time
100 (1)
HOLD# Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# Non Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# Non Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
HOLD# enable to Output Invalid
HOLD# disable to Output Valid
5
5
5
5
14
14
tLZ
Notes:
1. Only applicable as a constraint for WRR instruction when SRWD is set to a 1.
2. CL = 30 pF.
3. CL = 15 pF.
4. ±10% duty cycle is supported for frequencies 50 MHz.
5. Maximum value only applies during Program/Erase Suspend/Resume commands.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 32 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5.4.1 Clock Timing
Figure 30. Clock Timing
PSCK
tCH
tCL
VIH min
VIO / 2
VIL max
tCFT
tCRT
5.4.2 Input / Output Timing
Figure 31. SPI Single Bit Input Timing
tCS
CS#
tCSH
tCSH
tCSS
tCSS
SCK
tSU
tHD
MSB IN
SI
LSB IN
SO
Figure 32. SPI Single Bit Output Timing
tCS
CS#
SCK
SI
tLZ
tHO
tV
tDIS
SO
MSB OUT
LSB OUT
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 33 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 33. SPI SDR MIO Timing
tCS
CS#
tCSS
tCSH
tCSS
tSU
SCK
tHD
tLZ
tHO
tV
tDIS
MSB IN
LSB IN
.
MSB OUT
.
LSB OUT
IO
Figure 5.1 Hold Timing
CS#
SCK
tHLCH
tHHCH
tHLCH
tCHHL
tHHCH
tCHHH
tCHHL
tCHHH
HOLD#
Hold Condition
Standard Use
Hold Condition
Non-standard Use
SI_or_IO_(during_input)
tHZ
tLZ
B
tHZ
tLZ
SO_or_IO_(during_output)
A
B
C
D
E
Figure 34. WP# Input Timing
CS#
tWPS
WP#
SCK
tWPH
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
Phase
WRR Instruction
Input Data
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 34 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5.5
DDR AC Characteristics
Table 14. AC Characteristics — DDR Operation
66 MHz
Typ
80 MHz
Unit
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Typ
Max
SCK Clock Frequency for DDR READ
instruction
FSCK, R
PSCK, R
DC
66
DC
80
MHz
ns
SCK Clock Period for DDR READ
instruction
15
12.5
tWH, tCH Clock High Time
tWL, tCL Clock Low Time
45% PSCK
45% PSCK
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ps
45% PSCK
45% PSCK
tCS
tCSS
tCSH
tSU
tHD
tV
CS# High Time (Read Instructions)
10
3
10
3
CS# Active Setup Time (relative to SCK)
CS# Active Hold Time (relative to SCK)
IO in Setup Time
3
3
2
3000 (2)
6.5 (1)
1.5
1.5
3000 (2)
6.5 (1)
IO in Hold Time
2
Clock Low to Output Valid
Output Hold Time
tHO
tDIS
tLZ
1.5
0
1.5
0
Output Disable Time
8
8
8
8
Clock to Output Low Impedance
tO_SKEW First Output to last Output data valid time
600
600
Notes:
1. Regulated V range (3.0 - 3.6V) and CL =15 pF.
CC
2. Maximum value only applies during Program/Erase Suspend/Resume commands.
5.5.1 DDR Input Timing
Figure 35. SPI DDR Input Timing
tCS
CS#
SCK
tCSH
tCSH
tCSS
tCSS
tHD
tSU
tHD
tSU
SI_or_IO
SO
MSB IN
LSB IN
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 35 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
5.5.2 DDR Output Timing
Figure 36. SPI DDR Output Timing
tCS
CS#
SCK
SI
tLZ
tV
tV
tDIS
tHO
SO_or_IO
MSB
LSB
Figure 37. SPI DDR Data Valid Window
PSCK
tCL
tCH
SCK
tV
tV
tOTT
tO_SKEW
Slow
D1
Slow
D2
IO0
IO1
IO2
Fast
D1
Fast
D2
IO3
D1
Valid
D2
Valid
IO_valid
tDV
tDV
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
4.
t
t
t
t
is the shorter duration of t or t
.
CH
CLH
CL
is the maximum difference (delta) between the minimum and maximum t (output valid) across all IO signals.
O_SKEW
V
is the maximum Output Transition Time from one valid data value to the next valid data value on each IO.
is dependent on system level considerations including:
OTT
OTT
a. Memory device output impedance (drive strength).
b. System level parasitics on the IOs (primarily bus capacitance).
c. Host memory controller input v and v levels at which 0 to 1 and 1 to 0 transitions are recognized.
IH
IL
d. As an example, assuming that the above considerations result a memory output slew rate of 2V/ns and a 3V transition (from 1 to 0 or 0 to 1) is required by the host,
the t would be:
OTT
t
t
= 3V/(2V/ns) = 1.5 ns
OTT
OTT
e.
is not a specification tested by Cypress, it is system dependent and must be derived by the system designer based on the above considerations.
5. The minimum data valid window (t ) can be calculated as follows:
DV
a. As an example, assuming:
i. 80 MHz clock frequency = 12.5 ns clock period
ii. DDR operations are specified to have a duty cycle of 45% or higher
iii. t
iv. t
= 0.45*PSCK = 0.45x12.5 ns = 5.625 ns
CLH
= 600 ps
O_SKEW
v. t
= 1.5 ns
OTT
b.
c.
t
t
= t
- t - t
DV
DV
CLH O_SKEW OTT
= 5.625 ns - 600 ps - 1.5 ns = 3.525 ns
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 36 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6. Physical Interface
Table 15. Model Specific Connections
Versatile I/O or RFU — Some device models bond this connector to the device I/O power supply,
other models bond the device I/O supply to Vcc within the package leaving this package connector
unconnected.
VIO / RFU
RESET# or RFU — Some device models bond this connector to the device RESET# signal, other
models bond the RESET# signal to Vcc within the package leaving this package connector
unconnected.
RESET# / RFU
Note:
Refer to Table 2, Signal List on page 8 for signal descriptions.
6.1
SOIC 16-Lead Package
6.1.1 SOIC 16 Connection Diagram
Figure 38. 16-Lead SOIC Package, Top View
16
15
14
SCK
1
2
3
HOLD#/IO3
VCC
SI/IO0
VIO/RFU
RESET#/RFU
DNU
13
12
4
5
NC
DNU
DNU
RFU
6
11
DNU
VSS
CS#
7
8
10
9
SO/IO1
WP#/IO2
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 37 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6.1.2 SOIC 16 Physical Diagram
S03016 — 16-Lead Wide Plastic Small Outline Package (300-mil Body Width)
0.20
C
A-B
0.10
C
D
2X
0.33
C
0.25
0.10
M
C A-B D
C
0.10
C
DIMENSIONS
NOTES:
SYMBOL
MIN.
NOM.
MAX.
2.65
1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
2. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ASME Y14.5M - 1994.
A
A1
A2
b
2.35
0.10
2.05
-
3. DIMENSION D DOES NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH, PROTRUSIONS OR GATE BURRS.
MOLD FLASH, PROTRUSIONS OR GATE BURRS SHALL NOT EXCEED 0.15 mm PER
END. DIMENSION E1 DOES NOT INCLUDE INTERLEAD FLASH OR PROTRUSION.
INTERLEAD FLASH OR PROTRUSION SHALL NOT EXCEED 0.25 mm PER SIDE.
D AND E1 DIMENSIONS ARE DETERMINED AT DATUM H.
4. THE PACKAGE TOP MAY BE SMALLER THAN THE PACKAGE BOTTOM. DIMENSIONS
D AND E1 ARE DETERMINED AT THE OUTMOST EXTREMES OF THE PLASTIC BODY
EXCLUSIVE OF MOLD FLASH, TIE BAR BURRS, GATE BURRS AND INTERLEAD
FLASH, BUT INCLUSIVE OF ANY MISMATCH BETWEEN THE TOP AND BOTTOM OF
THE PLASTIC BODY.
-
0.30
2.55
0.51
0.48
-
0.31
0.27
0.20
0.20
-
b1
c
-
0.33
0.30
-
-
c1
5. DATUMS A AND B TO BE DETERMINED AT DATUM H.
6. "N" IS THE MAXIMUM NUMBER OF TERMINAL POSITIONS FOR THE SPECIFIED
PACKAGE LENGTH.
7. THE DIMENSIONS APPLY TO THE FLAT SECTION OF THE LEAD BETWEEN 0.10 TO
0.25 mm FROM THE LEAD TIP.
8. DIMENSION "b" DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION SHALL BE 0.10 mm TOTAL IN EXCESS OF THE "b" DIMENSION AT
MAXIMUM MATERIAL CONDITION. THE DAMBAR CANNOT BE LOCATED ON THE
LOWER RADIUS OF THE LEAD FOOT.
D
E
10.30 BSC
10.30 BSC
7.50 BSC
E1
e
1.27 BSC
-
L
1.27
0.40
L1
L2
N
9. THIS CHAMFER FEATURE IS OPTIONAL. IF IT IS NOT PRESENT, THEN A PIN 1
IDENTIFIER MUST BE LOCATED WITHIN THE INDEX AREA INDICATED.
10. LEAD COPLANARITY SHALL BE WITHIN 0.10 mm AS MEASURED FROM THE
SEATING PLANE.
1.40 REF
0.25 BSC
16
h
0.25
0°
-
-
-
-
0.75
8°
0
0 1
0 2
5°
15°
-
0°
CYPRESS
Company Confidential
TITLE
PACKAGE OUTLINE, 16 LEAD SOIC
10.30X7.50X2.65 MM SO3016/SL3016/SS3016
DRAWN BY
KOTA
DATE
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS INFORMATION WHICH IS THE PROPRIETARY PROPERTY OF CYPRESS
SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION. THIS DRAWING IS RECEIVED IN CONFIDENCE AND ITS CONTENTS
MAY NOT BE DISCLOSED WITHOUT WRITTEN CONSENT OF CYPRESS SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION.
SPEC NO.
REV
24-OCT-16
PACKAGE
CODE(S)
002-15547
SCALE :
TO FIT
SO3016 SL3016 SS3016
APPROVED BY
BESY
DATE
*A
24-OCT-16
SHEET
OF
1
2
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 38 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6.2
WSON Package
6.2.1 WSON Connection Diagram
Figure 39. Leadless Package (WSON), Top View
CS#
VCC
8
7
6
1
2
SO/IO1
HOLD#/IO3
WSON
WP#/IO2
VSS
3
4
SCK
SI/IO0
5
Note:
RESET# and V are pulled to V internal to the memory device.
IO
CC
6.2.2 WSON Physical Diagram
WNG008 — WSON 8-Contact (6 x 8 mm) No-Lead Package
NOTES:
DIMENSIONS
SYMBOL
e
N
ND
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING CONFORMS TO ASME Y14.5M-1994.
2. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
3. N IS THE TOTAL NUMBER OF TERMINALS.
MIN.
0.45
NOM.
MAX.
0.55
1.27 BSC.
8
4
0.50
4
DIMENSION "b" APPLIES TO METALLIZED TERMINAL AND IS MEASURED
BETWEEN 0.15 AND 0.30mm FROM TERMINAL TIP. IF THE TERMINAL HAS
THE OPTIONAL RADIUS ON THE OTHER END OF THE TERMINAL, THE
DIMENSION "b" SHOULD NOT BE MEASURED IN THAT RADIUS AREA.
ND REFERS TO THE NUMBER OF TERMINALS ON D SIDE.
L
b
D2
E2
D
0.35
4.70
4.55
0.40
4.80
0.45
4.90
4.75
5
4.65
6.00 BSC
6. MAX. PACKAGE WARPAGE IS 0.05mm.
7.
MAXIMUM ALLOWABLE BURR IS 0.076mm IN ALL DIRECTIONS.
PIN #1 ID ON TOP WILL BE LOCATED WITHIN THE INDICATED ZONE.
BILATERAL COPLANARITY ZONE APPLIES TO THE EXPOSED HEAT SINK
SLUG AS WELL AS THE TERMINALS.
E
A
A1
8.00 BSC
0.75
0.02
8
9
0.70
0.00
0.80
0.05
0.20 REF
A3
K
10 A MAXIMUM 0.15mm PULL BACK (L1) MAY BE PRESENT.
0.20 MIN.
CYPRESS
Company Confidential
PACKAGE OUTLINE, LEAD DFN
6.0X8.0X0.8 MM WNG008 4.80X4.65 MM EPAD (SAWN)
SPEC NO. REV
TITLE
8
DRAWN BY
KOTA
DATE
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS INFORMATION WHICH IS THE PROPRIETARY PROPERTY OF CYPRESS
SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION. THIS DRAWING IS RECEIVED IN CONFIDENCE AND ITS CONTENTS
MAY NOT BE DISCLOSED WITHOUT WRITTEN CONSENT OF CYPRESS SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION.
17-FEB-17
PACKAGE
CODE(S)
002-18827
SCALE :
TO FIT
WNG008
APPROVED BY
LKSU
DATE
**
OF
17-FEB-17
SHEET
1
2
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 39 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6.3
FAB024 24-Ball BGA Package
6.3.1 Connection Diagram
Figure 40. 24-Ball BGA, 5 x 5 Ball Footprint (FAB024), Top View
1
2
3
4
5
A
B
C
D
E
NC
NC
VSS
RESET#/
RFU
NC
NC
NC
DNU
DNU
DNU
NC
SCK
CS#
VCC
RFU WP#/IO2
SO/IO1 SI/IO0 HOLD#/IO3 NC
NC
NC
VIO/RFU
NC
Note:
Signal connections are in the same relative positions as FAC024 BGA, allowing a single PCB footprint to use either package.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 40 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6.3.2 FAB024 24-Ball BGA Package Physical Diagram
FAB024 — 24-Ball BGA (8 x 6 mm) Package
NOTES:
DIMENSIONS
SYMBOL
MIN.
NOM.
MAX.
1.
2.
3.
DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING METHODS PER ASME Y14.5M-1994.
A
A1
D
-
-
-
1.20
-
ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
0.20
BALL POSITION DESIGNATION PER JEP95, SECTION 3, SPP-020.
8.00 BSC
4.
5.
e REPRESENTS THE SOLDER BALL GRID PITCH.
E
6.00 BSC
4.00 BSC
4.00 BSC
5
D1
E1
MD
ME
N
SYMBOL "MD" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "D" DIRECTION.
SYMBOL "ME" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "E" DIRECTION.
N IS THE NUMBER OF POPULATED SOLDER BALL POSITIONS FOR MATRIX SIZE MD X ME.
5
6
7
DIMENSION "b" IS MEASURED AT THE MAXIMUM BALL DIAMETER IN A PLANE
PARALLEL TO DATUM C.
24
0.40
b
0.35
0.45
"SD" AND "SE" ARE MEASURED WITH RESPECT TO DATUMS A AND B AND DEFINE THE
POSITION OF THE CENTER SOLDER BALL IN THE OUTER ROW.
eE
eD
SD
SE
1.00 BSC
1.00 BSC
0.00 BSC
0.00 BSC
WHEN THERE IS AN ODD NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE OUTER ROW, "SD" OR "SE" = 0.
WHEN THERE IS AN EVEN NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE OUTER ROW, "SD" = eD/2 AND
"SE" = eE/2.
8.
9.
"+" INDICATES THE THEORETICAL CENTER OF DEPOPULATED BALLS.
A1 CORNER TO BE IDENTIFIED BY CHAMFER, LASER OR INK MARK,
METALLIZED MARK INDENTATION OR OTHER MEANS.
CYPRESS
Company Confidential
TITLE
PACKAGE OUTLINE, 24 BALL FBGA
8.0X6.0X1.2 MM FAB024
DRAWN BY
KOTA
DATE
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS INFORMATION WHICH IS THE PROPRIETARY PROPERTY OF CYPRESS
SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION. THIS DRAWING IS RECEIVED IN CONFIDENCE AND ITS CONTENTS
MAY NOT BE DISCLOSED WITHOUT WRITTEN CONSENT OF CYPRESS SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION.
SPEC NO.
REV
**
OF
18-JUL-16
PACKAGE
CODE(S)
002-15534
SCALE :
TO FIT
FAB024
APPROVED BY
BESY
DATE
18-JUL-16
SHEET
1
2
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 41 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6.4
FAC024 24-Ball BGA Package
6.4.1 Connection Diagram
Figure 41. 24-Ball BGA, 4 x 6 Ball Footprint (FAC024), Top View
1
2
3
4
A
B
C
D
NC
NC
NC
VSS
RESET#/
RFU
DNU
DNU
DNU
SCK
CS#
VCC
RFU WP#/IO2
SO/IO1 SI/IO0 HOLD#/IO3
E
F
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
VIO/RFU
NC
Note:
1. Signal connections are in the same relative positions as FAB024 BGA, allowing a single PCB footprint to use either package.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 42 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
6.4.2 FAC024 24-Ball BGA Package Physical Diagram
FAC024 — 24-Ball BGA (6 x 8 mm) Package
NOTES:
DIMENSIONS
SYMBOL
MIN.
-
NOM.
MAX.
1.20
-
1.
2.
3.
DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING METHODS PER ASME Y14.5M-1994.
A
A1
D
-
-
ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
0.25
BALL POSITION DESIGNATION PER JEP95, SECTION 3, SPP-020.
8.00 BSC
4.
5.
e
REPRESENTS THE SOLDER BALL GRID PITCH.
E
6.00 BSC
5.00 BSC
3.00 BSC
6
SYMBOL "MD" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "D" DIRECTION.
D1
E1
MD
ME
N
SYMBOL "ME" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "E" DIRECTION.
N IS THE NUMBER OF POPULATED SOLDER BALL POSITIONS FOR MATRIX SIZE MD X ME.
4
6
7
DIMENSION "b" IS MEASURED AT THE MAXIMUM BALL DIAMETER IN A PLANE
PARALLEL TO DATUM C.
24
0.40
b
0.35
0.45
"SD" AND "SE" ARE MEASURED WITH RESPECT TO DATUMS A AND B AND DEFINE THE
POSITION OF THE CENTER SOLDER BALL IN THE OUTER ROW.
eE
eD
SD
SE
1.00 BSC
1.00 BSC
0.50 BSC
0.50 BSC
WHEN THERE IS AN ODD NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE OUTER ROW, "SD" OR "SE" = 0.
WHEN THERE IS AN EVEN NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE OUTER ROW, "SD" = eD/2 AND
"SE" = eE/2.
8.
9.
"+" INDICATES THE THEORETICAL CENTER OF DEPOPULATED BALLS.
A1 CORNER TO BE IDENTIFIED BY CHAMFER, LASER OR INK MARK,
METALLIZED MARK INDENTATION OR OTHER MEANS.
CYPRESS
Company Confidential
TITLE
PACKAGE OUTLINE, 24 BALL FBGA
8.0X6.0X1.2 MM FAC024
DRAWN BY
KOTA
DATE
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS INFORMATION WHICH IS THE PROPRIETARY PROPERTY OF CYPRESS
SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION. THIS DRAWING IS RECEIVED IN CONFIDENCE AND ITS CONTENTS
MAY NOT BE DISCLOSED WITHOUT WRITTEN CONSENT OF CYPRESS SEMICONDUCTOR CORPORATION.
SPEC NO.
REV
**
OF
18-JUL-16
PACKAGE
CODE(S)
002-15535
SCALE :
TO FIT
FAC024
APPROVED BY
BESY
DATE
18-JUL-16
SHEET
1
2
6.4.3 Special Handling Instructions for FBGA Packages
Flash memory devices in BGA packages may be damaged if exposed to ultrasonic cleaning methods. The package and/or data
integrity may be compromised if the package body is exposed to temperatures above 150°C for prolonged periods of time.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 43 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Software Interface
This section discusses the features and behaviors most relevant to host system software that interacts with S25FL128S and
S25FL256S memory devices.
7. Address Space Maps
7.1
Overview
7.1.1 Extended Address
The S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices support 32-bit addresses to enable higher density devices than allowed by previous
generation (legacy) SPI devices that supported only 24-bit addresses. A 24-bit byte resolution address can access only 16 Mbytes
(128 Mbits) of maximum density. A 32-bit byte resolution address allows direct addressing of up to a 4 Gbytes (32 Gbits) of address
space.
Legacy commands continue to support 24-bit addresses for backward software compatibility. Extended 32-bit addresses are
enabled in three ways:
Bank address register — a software (command) loadable internal register that supplies the high order bits of address when legacy
24-bit addresses are in use.
Extended address mode — a bank address register bit that changes all legacy commands to expect 32 bits of address supplied
from the host system.
New commands — that perform both legacy and new functions, which expect 32-bit address.
The default condition at power-up and after reset, is the Bank address register loaded with zeros and the extended address mode
set for 24-bit addresses. This enables legacy software compatible access to the first 128 Mbits of a device.
The S25FL128S device supports the extended address features in the same way but in essence ignores bits 31 to 24 of any
address because the main flash array only needs 24 bits of address. This enables simple migration from the 128-Mb density to
higher density devices without changing the address handling aspects of software.
7.1.2 Multiple Address Spaces
Many commands operate on the main flash memory array. Some commands operate on address spaces separate from the main
flash array. Each separate address space uses the full 32-bit address but may only define a small portion of the available address
space.
7.2
Flash Memory Array
The main flash array is divided into erase units called sectors. The sectors are organized either as a hybrid combination of 4-kB and
64-kB sectors, or as uniform 256-kbyte sectors. The sector organization depends on the device model selected, see Section 12.
Ordering Information on page 141.
Table 16. S25FL256S Sector and Memory Address Map, Bottom 4-kbyte Sectors
Address Range
Sector Size (kbyte)
Sector Count
Sector Range
Notes
(Byte Address)
00000000h-00000FFFh
:
SA00
:
4
32
Sector Starting Address
—
SA31
SA32
:
0001F000h-0001FFFFh
00020000h-0002FFFFh
:
Sector Ending Address
64
510
SA541
01FF0000h-01FFFFFFh
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 44 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 17. S25FL256S Sector and Memory Address Map, Top 4-kbyte Sectors
Address Range
Sector Size (kbyte)
Sector Count
Sector Range
Notes
(Byte Address)
0000000h-000FFFFh
:
SA00
:
64
510
Sector Starting Address
—
Sector Ending Address
SA509
SA510
:
01FD0000h-01FDFFFFh
01FE0000h-01FE0FFFh
:
4
32
SA541
01FFF000h-01FFFFFFh
Table 18. S25FL256S Sector and Memory Address Map, Uniform 256-kbyte Sectors
Sector Size (kbyte)
Sector Count
Sector Range
Address Range (8-bit)
0000000h-003FFFFh
:
Notes
SA00
:
Sector Starting Address
—
256
128
Sector Ending Address
SA127
1FC0000h-1FFFFFFh
Table 19. S25FL128S Sector and Memory Address Map, Bottom 4-kbyte Sectors
Address Range
(Byte Address)
Sector Size (kbyte)
Sector Count
Sector Range
Notes
SA00
:
00000000h-00000FFFh
4
32
:
Sector Starting Address
—
SA31
SA32
:
0001F000h-0001FFFFh
00020000h-0002FFFFh
:
Sector Ending Address
64
254
SA285
00FF0000h-00FFFFFFh
Table 20. S25FL128S Sector and Memory Address Map, Top 4-kbyte Sectors
Address Range
(Byte Address)
Sector Size (kbyte)
Sector Count
Sector Range
Notes
SA00
:
0000000h-000FFFFh
64
254
:
Sector Starting Address
—
SA253
SA254
:
00FD0000h-00FDFFFFh
00FE0000h-00FE0FFFh
:
Sector Ending Address
4
32
SA285
00FFF000h-00FFFFFFh
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 45 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 21. S25FL128S Sector and Memory Address Map, Uniform 256-kbyte Sectors
Sector Size (kbyte) Sector Count Sector Range
Address Range (Byte Address)
0000000h-003FFFFh
:
Notes
SA00
Sector Starting Address
—
256
64
:
Sector Ending Address
SA63
0FC0000h-0FFFFFFh
Note: These are condensed tables that use a couple of sectors as references. There are address ranges that are not explicitly listed.
All 256 kB sectors have the pattern XXX0000h-XXXFFFFh.
7.3
ID-CFI Address Space
The RDID command (9Fh) reads information from a separate flash memory address space for device identification (ID) and
Common Flash Interface (CFI) information. See Section 11.2 Device ID and Common Flash Interface (ID-CFI) Address Map
on page 124 for the tables defining the contents of the ID-CFI address space. The ID-CFI address space is programmed by Cypress
and read-only for the host system.
7.4
OTP Address Space
Each S25FL128S and S25FL256S memory device has a 1024-byte One Time Program (OTP) address space that is separate from
the main flash array. The OTP area is divided into 32, individually lockable, 32-byte aligned and length regions.
In the 32-byte region starting at address zero:
The 16 lowest address bytes are programmed by Cypress with a 128-bit random number. Only Cypress is able to program these
bytes.
The next 4 higher address bytes (OTP Lock Bytes) are used to provide one bit per OTP region to permanently protect each
region from programming. The bytes are erased when shipped from Cypress. After an OTP region is programmed, it can be
locked to prevent further programming, by programming the related protection bit in the OTP Lock Bytes.
The next higher 12 bytes of the lowest address region are Reserved for Future Use (RFU). The bits in these RFU bytes may be
programmed by the host system but it must be understood that a future device may use those bits for protection of a larger OTP
space. The bytes are erased when shipped from Cypress.
The remaining regions are erased when shipped from Cypress, and are available for programming of additional permanent data.
Refer to Figure 42 on page 47 for a pictorial representation of the OTP memory space.
The OTP memory space is intended for increased system security. OTP values, such as the random number programmed by
Cypress, can be used to “mate” a flash component with the system CPU/ASIC to prevent device substitution.
The configuration register FREEZE (CR1[0]) bit protects the entire OTP memory space from programming when set to 1. This allows
trusted boot code to control programming of OTP regions then set the FREEZE bit to prevent further OTP memory space
programming during the remainder of normal power-on system operation.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 46 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 42. OTP Address Space
32-byte OTP Region 31
32-byte OTP Region 30
32-byte OTP Region 29
.
.
.
When programmed to ‘0’
each lock bit protects its
related 32-byte region from
any further programming
32-byte OTP Region 3
32-byte OTP Region 2
32-byte OTP Region 1
32-byte OTP Region 0
...
Lock Bits 31 to 0
Reserved
Lock Bytes
16-byte Random Number
Contents of Region 0
{
Byte 1F
Byte 10
Byte 0
Table 22. OTP Address Map
Region
Byte Address Range (Hex)
Contents
Initial Delivery State (Hex)
Least Significant Byte of Cypress Programmed
Random Number
000
...
Cypress Programmed Ran-
dom Number
...
Most Significant Byte of Cypress Programmed
Random Number
00F
Region 0
Region Locking Bits
Byte 10 [bit 0] locks region 0 from programming
when = 0
010 to 013
All bytes = FF
...
Byte 13 [bit 7] locks region 31 from programming
when = 0
014 to 01F
020 to 03F
040 to 05F
...
Reserved for Future Use (RFU)
Available for User Programming
Available for User Programming
Available for User Programming
Available for User Programming
All bytes = FF
All bytes = FF
All bytes = FF
All bytes = FF
All bytes = FF
Region 1
Region 2
...
Region 31
3E0 to 3FF
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 47 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
7.5
Registers
Registers are small groups of memory cells used to configure how the S25FL-S memory device operates or to report the status of
device operations. The registers are accessed by specific commands. The commands (and hexadecimal instruction codes) used for
each register are noted in each register description. The individual register bits may be volatile, non-volatile, or One Time
Programmable (OTP). The type for each bit is noted in each register description. The default state shown for each bit refers to the
state after power-on reset, hardware reset, or software reset if the bit is volatile. If the bit is non-volatile or OTP, the default state is
the value of the bit when the device is shipped from Cypress. Non-volatile bits have the same cycling (erase and program)
endurance as the main flash array.
Table 23. Register Descriptions
Register
Abbreviation
Type
Volatile
Bit Location
Status Register 1
SR1[7:0]
CR1[7:0]
SR2[7:0]
7:0
7:0
7:0
31:0
7:0
7:0
15:1
0
Configuration Register 1
Status Register 2
AutoBoot Register
Bank Address Register
ECC Status Register
ASP Register
Volatile
RFU
ABRD[31:0]
BRAC[7:0]
ECCSR[7:0]
ASPR[15:1]
ASPR[0]
Non-volatile
Volatile
Volatile
OTP
ASP Register
RFU
Password Register
PPB Lock Register
PASS[63:0]
PPBL[7:1]
Non-volatile OTP
Volatile
63:0
7:1
Volatile
Read Only
PPB Lock Register
PPBL[0]
0
PPB Access Register
PPBAR[7:0]
DYBAR[7:0]
NVDLR[7:0]
VDLR[7:0]
Non-volatile
Volatile
7:0
7:0
7:0
7:0
DYB Access Register
SPI DDR Data Learning Registers
SPI DDR Data Learning Registers
Non-volatile
Volatile
7.5.1 Status Register 1 (SR1)
Related Commands: Read Status Register (RDSR1 05h), Write Registers (WRR 01h), Write Enable (WREN 06h), Write Disable
(WRDI 04h), Clear Status Register (CLSR 30h).
Table 24. Status Register 1 (SR1)
Field
Name
Bits
Function
Type
Default State
Description
1 = Locks state of SRWD, BP, and configuration
register bits when WP# is low by ignoring WRR
command
Status Regis-
ter Write Dis-
able
7
SRWD
Non-Volatile
0
0
0 = No protection, even when WP# is low
1 = Error occurred.
0 = No Error
Programming
Error Occurred
6
5
P_ERR
E_ERR
Volatile, Read only
Volatile, Read only
1 = Error occurred
0 = No Error
Erase Error
Occurred
0
4
3
BP2
BP1
1 if CR1[3]=1,
Volatile if CR1[3]=1,
Non-Volatile if
CR1[3]=0
Block Protec-
tion
Protects selected range of sectors (Block) from
Program or Erase
0 when
shipped from
Cypress
2
BP0
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 48 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 24. Status Register 1 (SR1) (Continued)
Field
Bits
Function
Type
Default State
Description
Name
1 = Device accepts Write Registers (WRR), program
or erase commands
Write Enable
Latch
0 = Device ignores Write Registers (WRR), program
or erase commands
1
WEL
Volatile
0
This bit is not affected by WRR, only WREN and
WRDI commands affect this bit
1 = Device Busy, a Write Registers (WRR), program,
erase or other operation is in progress
0 = Ready Device is in standby mode and can accept
commands
Write in Prog-
ress
0
WIP
Volatile, Read only
0
The Status Register contains both status and control bits:
Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) SR1[7]: Places the device in the Hardware Protected mode when this bit is set to 1 and the
WP# input is driven low. In this mode, the SRWD, BP2, BP1, and BP0 bits of the Status Register become read-only bits and the
Write Registers (WRR) command is no longer accepted for execution. If WP# is high the SRWD bit and BP bits may be changed by
the WRR command. If SRWD is 0, WP# has no effect and the SRWD bit and BP bits may be changed by the WRR command. The
SRWD bit has the same non-volatile endurance as the main flash array.
Program Error (P_ERR) SR1[6]: The Program Error Bit is used as a program operation success or failure indication. When the
Program Error bit is set to a 1 it indicates that there was an error in the last program operation. This bit will also be set when the user
attempts to program within a protected main memory sector or locked OTP region. When the Program Error bit is set to a 1 this bit
can be reset to 0 with the Clear Status Register (CLSR) command. This is a read-only bit and is not affected by the WRR command.
Erase Error (E_ERR) SR1[5]: The Erase Error Bit is used as an Erase operation success or failure indication. When the Erase Error
bit is set to a 1 it indicates that there was an error in the last erase operation. This bit will also be set when the user attempts to erase
an individual protected main memory sector. The Bulk Erase command will not set E_ERR if a protected sector is found during the
command execution. When the Erase Error bit is set to a 1 this bit can be reset to 0 with the Clear Status Register (CLSR)
command. This is a read-only bit and is not affected by the WRR command.
Block Protection (BP2, BP1, BP0) SR1[4:2]: These bits define the main flash array area to be software-protected against program
and erase commands. The BP bits are either volatile or non-volatile, depending on the state of the BP non-volatile bit (BPNV) in the
configuration register. When one or more of the BP bits is set to 1, the relevant memory area is protected against program and
erase. The Bulk Erase (BE) command can be executed only when the BP bits are cleared to 0’s. See Block Protection on page 59
for a description of how the BP bit values select the memory array area protected. The BP bits have the same non-volatile
endurance as the main flash array.
Write Enable Latch (WEL) SR1[1]: The WEL bit must be set to 1 to enable program, write, or erase operations as a means to
provide protection against inadvertent changes to memory or register values. The Write Enable (WREN) command execution sets
the Write Enable Latch to a 1 to allow any program, erase, or write commands to execute afterwards. The Write Disable (WRDI)
command can be used to set the Write Enable Latch to a 0 to prevent all program, erase, and write commands from execution. The
WEL bit is cleared to 0 at the end of any successful program, write, or erase operation. Following a failed operation the WEL bit may
remain set and should be cleared with a WRDI command following a CLSR command. After a power down/power up sequence,
hardware reset, or software reset, the Write Enable Latch is set to a 0 The WRR command does not affect this bit.
Write In Progress (WIP) SR1[0]: Indicates whether the device is performing a program, write, erase operation, or any other
operation, during which a new operation command will be ignored. When the bit is set to a 1 the device is busy performing an
operation. While WIP is 1, only Read Status (RDSR1 or RDSR2), Erase Suspend (ERSP), Program Suspend (PGSP), Clear Status
Register (CLSR), and Software Reset (RESET) commands may be accepted. ERSP and PGSP will only be accepted if memory
array erase or program operations are in progress. The status register E_ERR and P_ERR bits are updated while WIP = 1. When
P_ERR or E_ERR bits are set to one, the WIP bit will remain set to one indicating the device remains busy and unable to receive
new operation commands. A Clear Status Register (CLSR) command must be received to return the device to standby mode. When
the WIP bit is cleared to 0 no operation is in progress. This is a read-only bit.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 49 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
7.5.2 Configuration Register 1 (CR1)
Related Commands: Read Configuration Register (RDCR 35h), Write Registers (WRR 01h). The Configuration Register bits can be
changed using the WRR command with sixteen input cycles.
The configuration register controls certain interface and data protection functions.
Table 25. Configuration Register 1(CR1)
Default
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
State
7
6
LC1
LC0
0
0
Selects number of initial read latency cycles
See Latency Code Tables
Latency Code
Non-Volatile
1 = BP starts at bottom (Low address)
0 = BP starts at top (High address)
Configures Start of
Block Protection
5
4
3
TBPROT
RFU
OTP
OTP
OTP
0
0
0
Reserved for Future Use
RFU
Configures BP2-0 in
Status Register
1 = Volatile
0 = Non-Volatile
BPNV
1 = 4-kB physical sectors at top, (high address)
0 = 4-kB physical sectors at bottom (Low address)
RFU in uniform sector devices
Configures Parame-
ter Sectors location
2
1
TBPARM
QUAD
OTP
0
0
Puts the device into
Quad I/O operation
1 = Quad
0 = Dual or Serial
Non-Volatile
Lock current state of
BP2-0 bits in Status
Register, TBPROT
and TBPARM in
1 = Block Protection and OTP locked
0 = Block Protection and OTP un-locked
0
FREEZE
Volatile
0
Configuration Regis-
ter, and OTP regions
Latency Code (LC) CR1[7:6]: The Latency Code selects the number of mode and dummy cycles between the end of address and
the start of read data output for all read commands.
Some read commands send mode bits following the address to indicate that the next command will be of the same type with an
implied, rather than an explicit, instruction. The next command thus does not provide an instruction byte, only a new address and
mode bits. This reduces the time needed to send each command when the same command type is repeated in a sequence of
commands.
Dummy cycles provide additional latency that is needed to complete the initial read access of the flash array before data can be
returned to the host system. Some read commands require additional latency cycles as the SCK frequency is increased.
The following latency code tables provide different latency settings that are configured by Cypress. The High Performance versus
the Enhanced High Performance settings are selected by the ordering part number.
Where mode or latency (dummy) cycles are shown in the tables as a dash, that read command is not supported at the frequency
shown. Read is supported only up to 50 MHz but the same latency value is assigned in each latency code and the command may be
used when the device is operated at 50 MHz with any latency code setting. Similarly, only the Fast Read command is supported
up to 133 MHz but the same 10b latency code is used for Fast Read up to 133 MHz and for the other dual and quad read commands
up to 104 MHz. It is not necessary to change the latency code from a higher to a lower frequency when operating at lower
frequencies where a particular command is supported. The latency code values for a higher frequency can be used for accesses at
lower frequencies.
The High Performance settings provide latency options that are the same or faster than alternate source SPI memories. These
settings provide mode bits only for the Quad I/O Read command.
The Enhanced High Performance settings similarly provide latency options the same or faster than additional alternate source SPI
memories and adds mode bits for the Dual I/O Read, DDR Fast Read, and DDR Dual I/O Read commands.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 50 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Read DDR Data Learning Pattern (DLP) bits may be placed within the dummy cycles immediately before the start of read data, if
there are 5 or more dummy cycles. See Section 9.4 Read Memory Array Commands on page 84 for more information on the DLP.
Table 26. Latency Codes for SDR High Performance
Read
Fast Read
(0Bh, 0Ch)
Read Dual Out
(3Bh, 3Ch)
Read Quad Out
(6Bh, 6Ch)
Dual I/O Read
(BBh, BCh)
Quad I/O Read
(EBh, ECh)
Freq.
(MHz)
LC
(03h, 13h)
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
≤ 50
≤ 80
≤ 90
≤104
≤133
11
00
01
10
10
0
-
0
-
0
0
0
0
0
0
8
8
8
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
-
0
8
8
8
-
0
4
2
1
0
0
0
-
8
8
8
-
0
0
0
-
4
5
6
-
2
2
2
-
4
4
5
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Table 27. Latency Codes for DDR High Performance
DDR Fast Read
DDR Dual I/O Read
(BDh, BEh)
Read DDR Quad I/O
(EDh, EEh)
Freq. (MHz)
LC
(0Dh, 0Eh)
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
≤ 50
≤ 66
≤ 66
≤ 66
11
00
01
10
0
0
0
0
4
5
6
7
0
0
0
0
4
6
7
8
1
1
1
1
3
6
7
8
Table 28. Latency Codes for SDR Enhanced High Performance
Read
Fast Read
(0Bh, 0Ch)
Read Dual Out
(3Bh, 3Ch)
Read Quad Out
(6Bh, 6Ch)
Dual I/O Read
(BBh, BCh)
Quad I/O Read
(EBh, ECh)
Freq.
(MHz)
LC
(03h, 13h)
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
≤ 50
≤ 80
≤ 90
≤104
≤133
11
00
01
10
10
0
-
0
-
0
0
0
0
0
0
8
8
8
8
0
0
0
0
-
0
8
8
8
-
0
0
0
0
-
0
8
8
8
-
4
0
2
2
2
2
-
1
4
4
5
-
4
4
4
-
0
1
2
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Table 29. Latency Codes for DDR Enhanced High Performance
DDR Fast Read
DDR Dual I/O Read
(BDh, BEh)
Read DDR Quad I/O
(EDh, EEh)
Freq. (MHz)
LC
(0Dh, 0Eh)
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
Mode
Dummy
≤ 50
≤ 66
≤ 66
≤ 66
≤ 80
≤ 80
≤ 80
11
00
01
10
00
01
10
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
1
2
4
5
2
4
5
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
4
5
6
4
5
6
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
6
7
8
6
7
8
Note:
1. When using DDR I/O commands with the Data Learning Pattern (DLP) enabled, a Latency Code that provides 5 or more dummy cycles should be selected to allow 1
cycle of additional time for the host to stop driving before the memory starts driving the 4 cycle DLP. It is recommended to use LC 10 for DDR Fast Read, LC 01 for
DDR Dual IO Read, and LC 00 for DDR Quad IO Read, if the Data Learning Pattern (DLP) for DDR is used.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 51 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Top or Bottom Protection (TBPROT) CR1[5]: This bit defines the operation of the Block Protection bits BP2, BP1, and BP0 in the
Status Register. As described in the status register section, the BP2-0 bits allow the user to optionally protect a portion of the array,
ranging from 1/64, 1/4, 1/2, etc., up to the entire array. When TBPROT is set to a 0 the Block Protection is defined to start from the
top (maximum address) of the array. When TBPROT is set to a 1 the Block Protection is defined to start from the bottom (zero
address) of the array. The TBPROT bit is OTP and set to a 0 when shipped from Cypress. If TBPROT is programmed to 1, an
attempt to change it back to 0 will fail and set the Program Error bit (P_ERR in SR1[6]).
The desired state of TBPROT must be selected during the initial configuration of the device during system manufacture; before the
first program or erase operation on the main flash array. TBPROT must not be programmed after programming or erasing is done in
the main flash array.
CR1[4]: Reserved for Future Use
Block Protection Non-Volatile (BPNV) CR1[3]: The BPNV bit defines whether or not the BP2-0 bits in the Status Register are
volatile or non-volatile. The BPNV bit is OTP and cleared to a0 with the BP bits cleared to 000 when shipped from Cypress. When
BPNV is set to a 0 the BP2-0 bits in the Status Register are non-volatile. When BPNV is set to a 1 the BP2-0 bits in the Status
Register are volatile and will be reset to binary 111 after POR, hardware reset, or command reset. If BPNV is programmed to 1, an
attempt to change it back to 0 will fail and set the Program Error bit (P_ERR in SR1[6]).
TBPARM CR1[2]: TBPARM defines the logical location of the parameter block. The parameter block consists of thirty-two 4-kB
small sectors (SMS), which replace two 64-kB sectors. When TBPARM is set to a 1 the parameter block is in the top of the memory
array address space. When TBPARM is set to a 0 the parameter block is at the Bottom of the array. TBPARM is OTP and set to a 0
when it ships from Cypress. If TBPARM is programmed to 1, an attempt to change it back to 0 will fail and set the Program Error bit
(P_ERR in SR1[6]).
The desired state of TBPARM must be selected during the initial configuration of the device during system manufacture; before the
first program or erase operation on the main flash array. TBPARM must not be programmed after programming or erasing is done in
the main flash array.
TBPROT can be set or cleared independent of the TBPARM bit. Therefore, the user can elect to store parameter information from
the bottom of the array and protect boot code starting at the top of the array, and vice versa. Or the user can select to store and
protect the parameter information starting from the top or bottom together.
When the memory array is logically configured as uniform 256-kB sectors, the TBPARM bit is Reserved for Future Use (RFU) and
has no effect because all sectors are uniform size.
Quad Data Width (QUAD) CR1[1]: When set to 1, this bit switches the data width of the device to 4 bit - Quad mode. That is, WP#
becomes IO2 and HOLD# becomes IO3. The WP# and HOLD# inputs are not monitored for their normal functions and are internally
set to high (inactive). The commands for Serial, Dual Output, and Dual I/O Read still function normally but, there is no need to drive
WP# and Hold# inputs for those commands when switching between commands using different data path widths. The QUAD bit
must be set to one when using Read Quad Out, Quad I/O Read, Read DDR Quad I/O, and Quad Page Program commands. The
QUAD bit is non-volatile.
Freeze Protection (FREEZE) CR1[0]: The Freeze Bit, when set to 1, locks the current state of the BP2-0 bits in Status Register, the
TBPROT and TBPARM bits in the Configuration Register, and the OTP address space. This prevents writing, programming, or
erasing these areas. As long as the FREEZE bit remains cleared to logic 0 the other bits of the Configuration Register, including
FREEZE, are writable, and the OTP address space is programmable. Once the FREEZE bit has been written to a logic 1 it can only
be cleared to a logic 0 by a power-off to power-on cycle or a hardware reset. Software reset will not affect the state of the FREEZE
bit. The FREEZE bit is volatile and the default state of FREEZE after power-on is 0. The FREEZE bit can be set in parallel with
updating other values in CR1 by a single WRR command.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 52 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
7.5.3 Status Register 2 (SR2)
Related Commands: Read Status Register 2 (RDSR2 07h).
Table 30. Status Register 2 (SR2)
Bits
7
Field Name
RFU
Function
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Type
Default State
Description
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
RFU
5
RFU
4
RFU
3
RFU
2
RFU
1 = In erase suspend mode
0 = Not in erase suspend mode
1
0
ES
PS
EraseSuspend Volatile, Read only
0
0
1 = In program suspend mode
0 = Not in program suspend mode
Program Sus-
Volatile, Read only
pend
Erase Suspend (ES) SR2[1]: The Erase Suspend bit is used to determine when the device is in Erase Suspend mode. This is a
status bit that cannot be written. When Erase Suspend bit is set to 1, the device is in erase suspend mode. When Erase Suspend bit
is cleared to 0, the device is not in erase suspend mode. Refer to Erase Suspend and Resume Commands (75h) (7Ah) for details
about the Erase Suspend/Resume commands.
Program Suspend (PS) SR2[0]: The Program Suspend bit is used to determine when the device is in Program Suspend mode.
This is a status bit that cannot be written. When Program Suspend bit is set to 1, the device is in program suspend mode. When the
Program Suspend bit is cleared to 0, the device is not in program suspend mode. Refer to Section 9.5.4 Program Suspend (PGSP
85h) and Resume (PGRS 8Ah) on page 105 for details.
7.5.4 AutoBoot Register
Related Commands: AutoBoot Read (ABRD 14h) and AutoBoot Write (ABWR 15h).
The AutoBoot Register provides a means to automatically read boot code as part of the power-on reset, hardware reset, or software
reset process.
Table 31. AutoBoot Register
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Default State
Description
AutoBoot Start
Address
512 byte boundary address for the start of
boot code access
31 to 9
ABSA
Non-Volatile
000000h
Number of initial delay cycles between
CS# going low and the first bit of boot code
being transferred
AutoBoot Start
Delay
8 to 1
0
ABSD
ABE
Non-Volatile
Non-Volatile
00h
0
1 = AutoBoot is enabled
0 = AutoBoot is not enabled
AutoBoot Enable
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 53 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
7.5.5 Bank Address Register
Related Commands: Bank Register Access (BRAC B9h), Write Register (WRR 01h), Bank Register Read (BRRD 16h) and Bank
Register Write (BRWR 17h).
The Bank Address register supplies additional high order bits of the main flash array byte boundary address for legacy commands
that supply only the low order 24 bits of address. The Bank Address is used as the high bits of address (above A23) for all 3-byte
address commands when EXTADD=0. The Bank Address is not used when EXTADD = 1 and traditional 3-byte address commands
are instead required to provide all four bytes of address.
Table 32. Bank Address Register (BAR)
Bits Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
1 = 4-byte (32-bits) addressing required from command.
0 = 3-byte (24-bits) addressing from command + Bank
Address
Extended Address
Enable
7
EXTADD
Volatile
0b
6 to 1
0
RFU
Reserved
Volatile
Volatile
00000b
0
Reserved for Future Use
BA24
Bank Address
A24 for 256-Mbit device, RFU for lower density device
Extended Address (EXTADD) BAR[7]: EXTADD controls the address field size for legacy SPI commands. By default (power up
reset, hardware reset, and software reset), it is cleared to 0 for 3 bytes (24 bits) of address. When set to 1, the legacy commands will
require 4 bytes (32 bits) for the address field. This is a volatile bit.
7.5.6 ECC Status Register (ECCSR)
Related Commands: ECC Read (ECCRD 18h). ECCSR does not have user programmable non-volatile bits. All defined bits are
volatile read only status. The default state of these bits are set by hardware. See Section 9.5.1.1 Automatic ECC on page 100.
The status of ECC in each ECC unit is provided by the 8-bit ECC Status Register (ECCSR). The ECC Register Read command is
written followed by an ECC unit address. The contents of the status register then indicates, for the selected ECC unit, whether there
is an error in the ECC unit eight bit error correction code, the ECC unit of 16 Bytes of data, or that ECC is disabled for that ECC unit.
Table 33. ECC Status Register (ECCSR)
Default
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
Reserved for Future Use
State
7 to 3
RFU
Reserved
0
1 = Single Bit Error found in the ECC unit eight
bit error correction code
2
EECC
Error in ECC
Volatile, Read only
0
0 = No error.
1 = Single Bit Error corrected in ECC unit
data.
0 = No error.
Error in ECC unit
data
1
0
EECCD
ECCDI
Volatile, Read only
Volatile, Read only
0
0
1 = ECC is disabled in the selected ECC unit.
0 = ECC is enabled in the selected ECC unit.
ECC Disabled
ECCSR[2] = 1 indicates an error was corrected in the ECC. ECCSR[1] = 1 indicates an error was corrected in the ECC unit data.
ECCSR[0] = 1 indicates the ECC is disabled. The default state of “0” for all these bits indicates no failures and ECC is enabled.
ECCSR[7:3] are reserved. These have undefined high or low values that can change from one ECC status read to another. These
bits should be treated as “don’t care” and ignored by any software reading status.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 54 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
7.5.7 ASP Register (ASPR)
Related Commands: ASP Read (ASPRD 2Bh) and ASP Program (ASPP 2Fh).
The ASP register is a 16-bit OTP memory location used to permanently configure the behavior of Advanced Sector Protection (ASP)
features.
Table 34. ASP Register (ASPR)
Default
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
State
15 to 9
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
1
Reserved for Future Use
8
7
6
5
4
3
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
1
Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
Password Pro-
tection Mode
Lock Bit
0 = Password Protection Mode permanently enabled.
1 = Password Protection Mode not permanently enabled.
2
PWDMLB
OTP
1
Persistent Pro-
tection Mode
Lock Bit
0 = Persistent Protection Mode permanently enabled.
1 = Persistent Protection Mode not permanently enabled.
1
0
PSTMLB
RFU
OTP
OTP
1
1
Reserved
Reserved for Future Use
Note:
1. Default value depends on ordering part number, see Initial Delivery State on page 140.
Reserved for Future Use (RFU) ASPR[15:3, 0].
Password Protection Mode Lock Bit (PWDMLB) ASPR[2]: When programmed to 0, the Password Protection Mode is
permanently selected.
Persistent Protection Mode Lock Bit (PSTMLB) ASPR[1]: When programmed to 0, the Persistent Protection Mode is
permanently selected. PWDMLB and PSTMLB are mutually exclusive, only one may be programmed to zero.
7.5.8 Password Register (PASS)
Related Commands: Password Read (PASSRD E7h) and Password Program (PASSP E8h).
Table 35. Password Register (PASS)
Field
Bits
Function
Type
Default State
Description
Name
Non-volatile OTP storage of 64 bit password. The
password is no longer readable after the password
protection mode is selected by programming ASP register
bit 2 to zero.
Hidden Pass-
word
FFFFFFFF-
FFFFFFFFh
63 to 0
PWD
OTP
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 55 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
7.5.9 PPB Lock Register (PPBL)
Related Commands: PPB Lock Read (PLBRD A7h, PLBWR A6h)
Table 36. PPB Lock Register (PPBL)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Default State
Description
7 to 1
RFU
Reserved
Volatile
00h
Reserved for Future Use
0 = PPB array protected until next power
Persistent Protection Mode = 1 cycle or hardware reset
Password Protection Mode = 0 1 = PPB array may be programmed or
erased.
0
PPBLOCK Protect PPBArray Volatile
7.5.10 PPB Access Register (PPBAR)
Related Commands: PPB Read (PPBRD E2h)
Table 37. PPB Access Register (PPBAR)
Default
State
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
00h = PPB for the sector addressed by the PPBRD or
PPBP command is programmed to 0, protecting that
sector from program or erase operations.
FFh = PPB for the sector addressed by the PPBRD or
PPBP command is erased to 1, not protecting that
sector from program or erase operations.
Read or Program
per sector PPB
7 to 0
PPB
Non-volatile
FFh
7.5.11 DYB Access Register (DYBAR)
Related Commands: DYB Read (DYBRD E0h) and DYB Program (DYBP E1h).
Table 38. DYB Access Register (DYBAR)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
00h = DYB for the sector addressed by the DYBRD or DYBP
command is cleared to 0, protecting that sector from program or
erase operations.
FFh = DYB for the sector addressed by the DYBRD or DYBP
command is set to 1, not protecting that sector from program or
erase operations.
Read or Write
per sector DYB
7 to 0
DYB
Volatile
FFh
7.5.12 SPI DDR Data Learning Registers
Related Commands: Program NVDLR (PNVDLR 43h), Write VDLR (WVDLR 4Ah), Data Learning Pattern Read (DLPRD 41h).
The Data Learning Pattern (DLP) resides in an 8-bit Non-Volatile Data Learning Register (NVDLR) as well as an 8-bit Volatile Data
Learning Register (VDLR). When shipped from Cypress, the NVDLR value is 00h. Once programmed, the NVDLR cannot be
reprogrammed or erased; a copy of the data pattern in the NVDLR will also be written to the VDLR. The VDLR can be written to at
any time, but on reset or power cycles the data pattern will revert back to what is in the NVDLR. During the learning phase described
in the SPI DDR modes, the DLP will come from the VDLR. Each IO will output the same DLP value for every clock edge. For
example, if the DLP is 34h (or binary 00110100) then during the first clock edge all IO’s will output 0; subsequently, the 2nd clock
edge all I/O’s will output 0, the 3rd will output 1, etc.
When the VDLR value is 00h, no preamble data pattern is presented during the dummy phase in the DDR commands.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 56 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 39. Non-Volatile Data Learning Register (NVDLR)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
OTP value that may be transferred to the host during DDR read
command latency (dummy) cycles to provide a training pattern to
help the host more accurately center the data capture point in
the received data bits.
Non-Volatile
Data Learning
Pattern
7 to 0
NVDLP
OTP
00h
Table 40. Volatile Data Learning Register (NVDLR)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
Takes the
value of
NVDLR
Volatile Data
Learning Pat- Volatile
tern
Volatile copy of the NVDLP used to enable and deliver the Data
Learning Pattern (DLP) to the outputs. The VDLP may be
7 to 0
VDLP
during POR changed by the host during system operation.
or Reset
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 57 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
8. Data Protection
8.1
Secure Silicon Region (OTP)
The device has a 1024-byte One Time Program (OTP) address space that is separate from the main flash array. The OTP area is
divided into 32, individually lockable, 32-byte aligned and length regions.
The OTP memory space is intended for increased system security. OTP values can “mate” a flash component with the system CPU/
ASIC to prevent device substitution. See Section 7.4 OTP Address Space on page 46, Section 9.7 One Time Program Array
Commands on page 111, and Section 9.7.2 OTP Read (OTPR 4Bh) on page 112.
8.1.1 Reading OTP Memory Space
The OTP Read command uses the same protocol as Fast Read. OTP Read operations outside the valid 1-kB OTP address range
will yield indeterminate data.
8.1.2 Programming OTP Memory Space
The protocol of the OTP programming command is the same as Page Program. The OTP Program command can be issued multiple
times to any given OTP address, but this address space can never be erased.
Automatic ECC is programmed on the first programming operation to each 16-byte region. Programming within a 16-byte region
more than once disables the ECC. It is recommended to program each 16-byte portion of each 32-byte region once so that ECC
remains enabled to provide the best data integrity.
The valid address range for OTP Program is depicted in Figure 42 on page 47. OTP Program operations outside the valid OTP
address range will be ignored and the WEL in SR1 will remain high (set to 1). OTP Program operations while FREEZE = 1 will fail
with P_ERR in SR1 set to 1.
8.1.3 Cypress Programmed Random Number
Cypress standard practice is to program the low order 16 bytes of the OTP memory space (locations 0x0 to 0xF) with a 128-bit
random number using the Linear Congruential Random Number Method. The seed value for the algorithm is a random number
concatenated with the day and time of tester insertion.
8.1.4 Lock Bytes
The LSB of each Lock byte protects the lowest address region related to the byte, the MSB protects the highest address region
related to the byte. The next higher address byte similarly protects the next higher 8 regions. The LSB bit of the lowest address Lock
Byte protects the higher address 16 bytes of the lowest address region. In other words, the LSB of location 0x10 protects all the Lock
Bytes and RFU bytes in the lowest address region from further programming. See Section 7.4 OTP Address Space on page 46.
8.2
Write Enable Command
The Write Enable (WREN) command must be written prior to any command that modifies non-volatile data. The WREN command
sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit. The WEL bit is cleared to 0 (disables writes) during power-up, hardware reset, or after the
device completes the following commands:
– Reset
– Page Program (PP)
– Sector Erase (SE)
– Bulk Erase (BE)
– Write Disable (WRDI)
– Write Registers (WRR)
– Quad-input Page Programming (QPP)
– OTP Byte Programming (OTPP)
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 58 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
8.3
Block Protection
The Block Protect bits (Status Register bits BP2, BP1, BP0) in combination with the Configuration Register TBPROT bit can be used
to protect an address range of the main flash array from program and erase operations. The size of the range is determined by the
value of the BP bits and the upper or lower starting point of the range is selected by the TBPROT bit of the configuration register.
Table 41. Upper Array Start of Protection (TBPROT = 0)
Status Register Content
BP1
Protected Memory (kbytes)
Protected Fraction
of Memory Array
FL128S
128 Mb
FL256S
256 Mb
BP2
BP0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
None
0
0
Upper 64th
Upper 32nd
Upper 16th
Upper 8th
Upper 4th
Upper Half
All Sectors
256
512
512
1024
2048
4096
8192
16384
32768
1024
2048
4096
8192
16384
Table 42. Lower Array Start of Protection (TBPROT = 1)
Status Register Content
Protected Memory (kbytes)
Protected Fraction
of Memory Array
FL128S
128 Mb
FL256S
256 Mb
BP2
BP1
BP0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
None
0
0
Lower 64th
Lower 32nd
Lower 16th
Lower 8th
Lower 4th
Lower Half
All Sectors
256
512
512
1024
2048
4096
8192
16384
32768
1024
2048
4096
8192
16384
When Block Protection is enabled (i.e., any BP2-0 are set to 1), Advanced Sector Protection (ASP) can still be used to protect
sectors not protected by the Block Protection scheme. In the case that both ASP and Block Protection are used on the same sector
the logical OR of ASP and Block Protection related to the sector is used. Recommendation: ASP and Block Protection should not be
used concurrently. Use one or the other, but not both.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 59 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
8.3.1 Freeze Bit
Bit 0 of the Configuration Register is the FREEZE bit. The FREEZE bit locks the BP2-0 bits in Status Register 1 and the TBPROT bit
in the Configuration Register to their value at the time the FREEZE bit is set to 1. Once the FREEZE bit has been written to a logic 1
it cannot be cleared to a logic 0 until a power-on-reset is executed. As long as the FREEZE bit is cleared to logic 0 the status register
BP bits and the TBPROT bit of the Configuration Register are writable. The FREEZE bit also protects the entire OTP memory space
from programming when set to 1. Any attempt to change the BP bits with the WRR command while FREEZE = 1 is ignored and no
error status is set.
8.3.2 Write Protect Signal
The Write Protect (WP#) input in combination with the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit provide hardware input signal
controlled protection. When WP# is Low and SRWD is set to 1 the Status and Configuration register is protected from alteration.
This prevents disabling or changing the protection defined by the Block Protect bits.
8.4
Advanced Sector Protection
Advanced Sector Protection (ASP) is the name used for a set of independent hardware and software methods used to disable or
enable programming or erase operations, individually, in any or all sectors. An overview of these methods is shown in Figure 43
on page 60.
Block Protection and ASP protection settings for each sector are logically OR’d to define the protection for each sector, i.e. if either
mechanism is protecting a sector the sector cannot be programmed or erased. Refer to Section 8.3 Block Protection on page 59 for
full details of the BP2-0 bits.
Figure 43. Advanced Sector Protection Overview
ASP Register
One Time Programmable
Password Method Persistent Method
(ASPR[2]=0)
(ASPR[1]=0)
6) Password Method requires a
password to set PPB Lock to ‘1’
to enable program or erase of
PPB bits
7) Persistent Method only allows
PPB Lock to be cleared to ‘0’ to
prevent program or erase of PPB
bits. Power off or hardware reset
required to set PPB Lock to ‘1’
64-bit Password
(One Time Protect)
4) PPB Lock bit is volatile and
defaults to ‘1’ (persistent mode), or
‘0’ (password mode) upon reset
PBB Lock Bit
‘0’ = PPBs locked
‘1’=PPBs unlocked
5) PPB Lock = ‘0’ locks all PPBs
to their current state
Persistent
Protection Bits
(PPB)
Dynamic
Protection Bits
(DYB)
Memory Array
Sector 0
Sector 1
Sector 2
PPB 0
PPB 1
PPB 2
DYB 0
DYB 1
DYB 2
Sector N-2
Sector N-1
Sector N
PPB N-2
PPB N-1
PPB N
DYB N-2
DYB N-1
DYB N
3) DYB are volatile bits
1) N = Highest Address Sector,
a sector is protected if its PPB =’0’
or its DYB = ‘0’
PPB are programmed individually
but erased as a group
2)
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 60 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Every main flash array sector has a non-volatile (PPB) and a volatile (DYB) protection bit associated with it. When either bit is 0, the
sector is protected from program and erase operations.
The PPB bits are protected from program and erase when the PPB Lock bit is 0. There are two methods for managing the state of
the PPB Lock bit, Persistent Protection and Password Protection.
The Persistent Protection method sets the PPB Lock bit to 1 during POR, or Hardware Reset so that the PPB bits are unprotected by
a device reset. There is a command to clear the PPB Lock bit to 0 to protect the PPB. There is no command in the Persistent
Protection method to set the PPB Lock bit to 1, therefore the PPB Lock bit will remain at 0 until the next power-off or hardware reset.
The Persistent Protection method allows boot code the option of changing sector protection by programming or erasing the PPB,
then protecting the PPB from further change for the remainder of normal system operation by clearing the PPB Lock bit to 0. This is
sometimes called Boot-code controlled sector protection.
The Password method clears the PPB Lock bit to 0 during POR, or Hardware Reset to protect the PPB. A 64-bit password may be
permanently programmed and hidden for the password method. A command can be used to provide a password for comparison with
the hidden password. If the password matches, the PPB Lock bit is set to 1 to unprotect the PPB. A command can be used to clear
the PPB Lock bit to 0. This method requires use of a password to control PPB protection.
The selection of the PPB Lock bit management method is made by programming OTP bits in the ASP Register so as to permanently
select the method used.
8.4.1 ASP Register
The ASP register is used to permanently configure the behavior of Advanced Sector Protection (ASP) features. See Table 34
on page 55.
As shipped from the factory, all devices default ASP to the Persistent Protection mode, with all sectors unprotected, when power is
applied. The device programmer or host system must then choose which sector protection method to use. Programming either of
the, one-time programmable, Protection Mode Lock Bits, locks the part permanently in the selected mode:
ASPR[2:1] = 11 = No ASP mode selected, Persistent Protection Mode is the default.
ASPR[2:1] = 10 = Persistent Protection Mode permanently selected.
ASPR[2:1] = 01 = Password Protection Mode permanently selected.
ASPR[2:1] = 00 = Illegal condition, attempting to program both bits to zero results in a programming failure.
ASP register programming rules:
If the password mode is chosen, the password must be programmed prior to setting the Protection Mode Lock Bits.
Once the Protection Mode is selected, the Protection Mode Lock Bits are permanently protected from programming and no further
changes to the ASP register is allowed.
The programming time of the ASP Register is the same as the typical page programming time. The system can determine the status
of the ASP register programming operation by reading the WIP bit in the Status Register. See Section 7.5.1 Status Register 1 (SR1)
on page 48 for information on WIP.
After selecting a sector protection method, each sector can operate in each of the following states:
Dynamically Locked — A sector is protected and can be changed by a simple command.
Persistently Locked — A sector is protected and cannot be changed if its PPB Bit is 0.
Unlocked — The sector is unprotected and can be changed by a simple command.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 61 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
8.4.2 Persistent Protection Bits
The Persistent Protection Bits (PPB) are located in a separate nonvolatile flash array. One of the PPB bits is related to each sector.
When a PPB is 0, its related sector is protected from program and erase operations. The PPB are programmed individually but must
be erased as a group, similar to the way individual words may be programmed in the main array but an entire sector must be erased
at the same time. The PPB have the same program and erase endurance as the main flash memory array. Preprogramming and
verification prior to erasure are handled by the device.
Programming a PPB bit requires the typical page programming time. Erasing all the PPBs requires typical sector erase time. During
PPB bit programming and PPB bit erasing, status is available by reading the Status register. Reading of a PPB bit requires the initial
access time of the device.
Notes:
Each PPB is individually programmed to 0 and all are erased to 1 in parallel.
If the PPB Lock bit is 0, the PPB Program or PPB Erase command does not execute and fails without programming or erasing the
PPB.
The state of the PPB for a given sector can be verified by using the PPB Read command.
8.4.3 Dynamic Protection Bits
Dynamic Protection Bits are volatile and unique for each sector and can be individually modified. DYB only control the protection for
sectors that have their PPB set to 1. By issuing the DYB Write command, a DYB is cleared to 0 or set to 1, thus placing each sector
in the protected or unprotected state respectively. This feature allows software to easily protect sectors against inadvertent changes,
yet does not prevent the easy removal of protection when changes are needed. The DYBs can be set or cleared as often as needed
as they are volatile bits.
8.4.4 PPB Lock Bit (PPBL[0])
The PPB Lock Bit is a volatile bit for protecting all PPB bits. When cleared to 0, it locks all PPBs and when set to 1, it allows the
PPBs to be changed.
The PLBWR command is used to clear the PPB Lock bit to 0. The PPB Lock Bit must be cleared to 0 only after all the PPBs are
configured to the desired settings.
In Persistent Protection mode, the PPB Lock is set to 1 during POR or a hardware reset. When cleared to 0, no software command
sequence can set the PPB Lock bit to 1, only another hardware reset or power-up can set the PPB Lock bit.
In the Password Protection mode, the PPB Lock bit is cleared to 0 during POR or a hardware reset. The PPB Lock bit can only be
set to 1 by the Password Unlock command.
8.4.5 Sector Protection States Summary
Each sector can be in one of the following protection states:
Unlocked — The sector is unprotected and protection can be changed by a simple command. The protection state defaults to
unprotected after a power cycle, software reset, or hardware reset.
Dynamically Locked — A sector is protected and protection can be changed by a simple command. The protection state is not
saved across a power cycle or reset.
Persistently Locked — A sector is protected and protection can only be changed if the PPB Lock Bit is set to 1. The protection
state is non-volatile and saved across a power cycle or reset. Changing the protection state requires programming and or erase of
the PPB bits
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 62 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 43. Sector Protection States
Protection Bit Values
Sector State
PPB Lock
PPB
DYB
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
Unprotected – PPB and DYB are changeable
Protected – PPB and DYB are changeable
Protected – PPB and DYB are changeable
Protected – PPB and DYB are changeable
Unprotected – PPB not changeable, DYB is changeable
Protected – PPB not changeable, DYB is changeable
Protected – PPB not changeable, DYB is changeable
Protected – PPB not changeable, DYB is changeable
8.4.6 Persistent Protection Mode
The Persistent Protection method sets the PPB Lock bit to 1 during POR or Hardware Reset so that the PPB bits are unprotected by
a device hardware reset. Software reset does not affect the PPB Lock bit. The PLBWR command can clear the PPB Lock bit to 0 to
protect the PPB. There is no command to set the PPB Lock bit therefore the PPB Lock bit will remain at 0 until the next power-off or
hardware reset.
8.4.7 Password Protection Mode
Password Protection Mode allows an even higher level of security than the Persistent Sector Protection Mode, by requiring a 64-bit
password for unlocking the PPB Lock bit. In addition to this password requirement, after power up and hardware reset, the PPB Lock
bit is cleared to 0 to ensure protection at power-up. Successful execution of the Password Unlock command by entering the entire
password clears the PPB Lock bit, allowing for sector PPB modifications.
Password Protection Notes:
Once the Password is programmed and verified, the Password Mode (ASPR[2]=0) must be set in order to prevent reading the
password.
The Password Program Command is only capable of programming ‘0’s. Programming a 1 after a cell is programmed as a 0
results in the cell left as a 0 with no programming error set.
The password is all 1’s when shipped from Cypress. It is located in its own memory space and is accessible through the use of the
Password Program and Password Read commands.
All 64-bit password combinations are valid as a password.
The Password Mode, once programmed, prevents reading the 64-bit password and further password programming. All further
program and read commands to the password region are disabled and these commands are ignored. There is no means to verify
what the password is after the Password Mode Lock Bit is selected. Password verification is only allowed before selecting the
Password Protection mode.
The Protection Mode Lock Bits are not erasable.
The exact password must be entered in order for the unlocking function to occur. If the password unlock command provided
password does not match the hidden internal password, the unlock operation fails in the same manner as a programming
operation on a protected sector. The P_ERR bit is set to one and the WIP Bit remains set. In this case it is a failure to change the
state of the PPB Lock bit because it is still protected by the lack of a valid password.
The Password Unlock command cannot be accepted any faster than once every 100 µs ± 20 µs. This makes it take an
unreasonably long time (58 million years) for a hacker to run through all the 64-bit combinations in an attempt to correctly match a
password. The Read Status Register 1 command may be used to read the WIP bit to determine when the device has completed
the password unlock command or is ready to accept a new password command. When a valid password is provided the password
unlock command does not insert the 100 µs delay before returning the WIP bit to zero.
If the password is lost after selecting the Password Mode, there is no way to set the PPB Lock bit.
ECC status may only be read from sectors that are readable. In read protection mode the addresses are forced to the boot sector
address. ECC status is shown in that sector while read protection mode is active.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 63 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9. Commands
All communication between the host system and S25FL128S and S25FL256S memory devices is in the form of units called
commands.
All commands begin with an instruction that selects the type of information transfer or device operation to be performed. Commands
may also have an address, instruction modifier, latency period, data transfer to the memory, or data transfer from the memory. All
instruction, address, and data information is transferred serially between the host system and memory device.
All instructions are transferred from host to memory as a single bit serial sequence on the SI signal.
Single bit wide commands may provide an address or data sent only on the SI signal. Data may be sent back to the host serially on
SO signal.
Dual or Quad Output commands provide an address sent to the memory only on the SI signal. Data will be returned to the host as a
sequence of bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or four bit (nibble) groups on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3.
Dual or Quad Input/Output (I/O) commands provide an address sent from the host as bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or, four bit (nibble)
groups on IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3. Data is returned to the host similarly as bit pairs on IO0 and IO1 or, four bit (nibble) groups on IO0,
IO1, IO2, and IO3.
Commands are structured as follows:
Each command begins with an eight bit (byte) instruction.
The instruction may be stand alone or may be followed by address bits to select a location within one of several address spaces
in the device. The address may be either a 24-bit or 32-bit byte boundary address.
The Serial Peripheral Interface with Multiple IO provides the option for each transfer of address and data information to be done
one, two, or four bits in parallel. This enables a trade off between the number of signal connections (IO bus width) and the speed
of information transfer. If the host system can support a two or four bit wide IO bus the memory performance can be increased by
using the instructions that provide parallel two bit (dual) or parallel four bit (quad) transfers.
The width of all transfers following the instruction are determined by the instruction sent.
All single bits or parallel bit groups are transferred in most to least significant bit order.
Some instructions send instruction modifier (mode) bits following the address to indicate that the next command will be of the
same type with an implied, rather than an explicit, instruction. The next command thus does not provide an instruction byte, only
a new address and mode bits. This reduces the time needed to send each command when the same command type is repeated
in a sequence of commands.
The address or mode bits may be followed by write data to be stored in the memory device or by a read latency period before
read data is returned to the host.
Read latency may be zero to several SCK cycles (also referred to as dummy cycles).
All instruction, address, mode, and data information is transferred in byte granularity. Addresses are shifted into the device with
the most significant byte first. All data is transferred with the lowest address byte sent first. Following bytes of data are sent in
lowest to highest byte address order i.e. the byte address increments.
All attempts to read the flash memory array during a program, erase, or a write cycle (embedded operations) are ignored. The
embedded operation will continue to execute without any affect. A very limited set of commands are accepted during an
embedded operation. These are discussed in the individual command descriptions. While a program, erase, or write operation is
in progress, it is recommended to check that the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit is 0 before issuing most commands to the device, to
ensure the new command can be accepted.
Depending on the command, the time for execution varies. A command to read status information from an executing command is
available to determine when the command completes execution and whether the command was successful.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 64 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Although host software in some cases is used to directly control the SPI interface signals, the hardware interfaces of the host
system and the memory device generally handle the details of signal relationships and timing. For this reason, signal relationships
and timing are not covered in detail within this software interface focused section of the document. Instead, the focus is on the
logical sequence of bits transferred in each command rather than the signal timing and relationships. Following are some general
signal relationship descriptions to keep in mind. For additional information on the bit level format and signal timing relationships of
commands, see Section 3.2 Command Protocol on page 14.
– The host always controls the Chip Select (CS#), Serial Clock (SCK), and Serial Input (SI) - SI for single bit wide transfers. The
memory drives Serial Output (SO) for single bit read transfers. The host and memory alternately drive the IO0-IO3
signals during Dual and Quad transfers.
– All commands begin with the host selecting the memory by driving CS# low before the first rising edge of SCK. CS# is kept
low throughout a command and when CS# is returned high the command ends. Generally, CS# remains low for 8-bit transfer
multiples to transfer byte granularity information. Some commands will not be accepted if CS# is returned high not at an 8-bit
boundary.
9.1
Command Set Summary
Extended Addressing
9.1.1
To accommodate addressing above 128 Mb, there are three options:
1. New instructions are provided with 4-byte address, used to access up to 32 Gb of memory.
Instruction Name
4FAST_READ
4READ
Description
Code (Hex)
Read Fast (4-byte Address)
0C
13
Read (4-byte Address)
4DOR
Read Dual Out (4-byte Address)
Read Quad Out (4-byte Address)
Dual I/O Read (4-byte Address)
Quad I/O Read (4-byte Address)
Read DDR Fast (4-byte Address)
DDR Dual I/O Read (4-byte Address)
DDR Quad I/O Read (4-byte Address)
Page Program (4-byte Address)
Quad Page Program (4-byte Address)
Parameter 4-kB Erase (4-byte Address)
Erase 64/256 kB (4-byte Address)
3C
6C
BC
EC
0E
BE
EE
12
4QOR
4DIOR
4QIOR
4DDRFR
4DDRDIOR
4DDRQIOR
4PP
4QPP
34
4P4E
21
4SE
DC
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 65 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
2. For backward compatibility to the 3-byte address instructions, the standard instructions can be used in conjunction with
the EXTADD Bit in the Bank Address Register (BAR[7]). By default BAR[7] is cleared to 0 (following power up and
hardware reset), to enable 3-byte (24-bit) addressing. When set to 1, the legacy commands are changed to require 4
bytes (32 bits) for the address field. The following instructions can be used in conjunction with EXTADD bit to switch from
3 bytes to 4 bytes of address field.
Instruction Name
READ
Description
Code (Hex)
Read (3-byte Address)
03
0B
3B
6B
BB
EB
0D
BD
ED
02
FAST_READ
DOR
Read Fast (3-byte Address)
Read Dual Out (3-byte Address)
Read Quad Out (3-byte Address)
Dual I/O Read (3-byte Address)
Quad I/O Read (3-byte Address)
Read DDR Fast (3-byte Address)
DDR Dual I/O Read (3-byte Address)
DDR Quad I/O Read (3-byte Address)
Page Program (3-byte Address)
Quad Page Program (3-byte Address)
Parameter 4-kB Erase (3-byte Address)
Erase 64 / 256 kB (3-byte Address)
QOR
DIOR
QIOR
DDRFR
DDRDIOR
DDRQIOR
PP
QPP
32
P4E
20
SE
D8
3. For backward compatibility to the 3-byte addressing, the standard instructions can be used in conjunction with the Bank
Address Register:
a. The Bank Address Register is used to switch between 128-Mbit (16-Mbyte) banks of memory, The standard 3-byte
address selects an address within the bank selected by the Bank Address Register.
i. The host system writes the Bank Address Register to access beyond the first 128 Mbits of
memory.
ii. This applies to read, erase, and program commands.
b. The Bank Register provides the high order (4th) byte of address, which is used to address the available memory at
addresses greater than 16 Mbytes.
c. Bank Register bits are volatile.
i. On power up, the default is Bank0 (the lowest address 16 Mbytes).
d. For Read, the device will continuously transfer out data until the end of the array.
i. There is no bank to bank delay.
ii. The Bank Address Register is not updated.
iii. The Bank Address Register value is used only for the initial address of an access.
Table 44. Bank Address Map
Bank Address Register Bits
Bank
Memory Array Address Range (Hex)
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
1
0
1
00000000
01000000
00FFFFFF
01FFFFFF
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 66 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 45. S25FL128S and S25FL256S Command Set (sorted by function)
Command
Maximum
Instruction
Function
Command Description
Frequency
Name
Value (Hex)
(MHz)
READ_ID
(REMS)
Read Electronic Manufacturer Signature
90
133
Read Device
Identification
RDID
RES
Read ID (JEDEC Manufacturer ID and JEDEC CFI)
Read Electronic Signature
9F
AB
05
07
35
01
04
06
30
18
133
50
RDSR1
RDSR2
RDCR
WRR
Read Status Register-1
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
Read Status Register-2
Read Configuration Register-1
Write Register (Status-1, Configuration-1)
Write Disable
WRDI
WREN
CLSR
ECCRD
Write Enable
Clear Status Register-1 - Erase/Prog. Fail Reset
ECC Read (4-byte address)
133
(QUAD=0)
104
Register Access
ABRD
AutoBoot Register Read
14
(QUAD=1)
ABWR
BRRD
BRWR
AutoBoot Register Write
Bank Register Read
Bank Register Write
15
16
17
133
133
133
Bank Register Access
(Legacy Command formerly used for Deep Power Down)
BRAC
B9
133
DLPRD
PNVDLR
WVDLR
Data Learning Pattern Read
41
43
4A
133
133
133
Program NV Data Learning Register
Write Volatile Data Learning Register
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 67 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 45. S25FL128S and S25FL256S Command Set (sorted by function) (Continued)
Command
Maximum
Instruction
Function
Command Description
Frequency
Name
Value (Hex)
(MHz)
READ
Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Read (4-byte address)
03
13
50
50
4READ
FAST_READ Fast Read (3- or 4-byte address)
4FAST_READ Fast Read (4-byte address)
0B
0C
0D
0E
3B
3C
6B
6C
BB
BC
BD
BE
EB
EC
ED
EE
02
133
133
80
DDRFR
4DDRFR
DOR
DDR Fast Read (3- or 4-byte address)
DDR Fast Read (4-byte address)
Read Dual Out (3- or 4-byte address)
Read Dual Out (4-byte address)
80
104
104
104
104
104
104
80
4DOR
QOR
Read Quad Out (3- or 4-byte address)
Read Quad Out (4-byte address)
Dual I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Dual I/O Read (4-byte address)
Read Flash Array
4QOR
DIOR
4DIOR
DDRDIOR
DDR Dual I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
4DDRDIOR DDR Dual I/O Read (4-byte address)
80
QIOR
4QIOR
Quad I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Quad I/O Read (4-byte address)
104
104
80
DDRQIOR
DDR Quad I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
4DDRQIOR DDR Quad I/O Read (4-byte address)
80
PP
4PP
Page Program (3- or 4-byte address)
Page Program (4-byte address)
Quad Page Program (3- or 4-byte address)
Quad Page Program - Alternate instruction (3- or 4-byte address)
Quad Page Program (4-byte address)
Program Suspend
133
133
80
12
QPP
QPP
4QPP
PGSP
PGRS
P4E
32
Program Flash
Array
38
80
34
80
85
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
Program Resume
8A
20
Parameter 4-kB, sector Erase (3- or 4-byte address)
Parameter 4-kB, sector Erase (4-byte address)
Bulk Erase
4P4E
BE
21
60
BE
Bulk Erase (alternate command)
Erase 64 kB or 256 kB (3- or 4-byte address)
Erase 64 kB or 256 kB (4-byte address)
Erase Suspend
C7
D8
DC
75
Erase Flash
Array
SE
4SE
ERSP
ERRS
OTPP
OTPR
Erase Resume
7A
42
OTP Program
One Time
Program Array
OTP Read
4B
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 68 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 45. S25FL128S and S25FL256S Command Set (sorted by function) (Continued)
Command
Maximum
Instruction
Function
Command Description
Frequency
Name
Value (Hex)
(MHz)
DYBRD
DYBWR
PPBRD
PPBP
DYB Read
E0
E1
E2
E3
E4
2B
2F
A7
A6
E7
E8
E9
F0
FF
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
DYB Write
PPB Read
PPB Program
PPB Erase
PPBE
ASPRD
ASPP
ASP Read
Advanced Sector
Protection
ASP Program
PPB Lock Bit Read
PPB Lock Bit Write
Password Read
Password Program
Password Unlock
Software Reset
Mode Bit Reset
PLBRD
PLBWR
PASSRD
PASSP
PASSU
RESET
MBR
Reset
Reserved for
Future Use
MPM
Reserved for Multi-I/O-High Perf Mode (MPM)
A3
133
RFU
RFU
RFU
Reserved-18 Reserved
Reserved-E5 Reserved
Reserved-E6 Reserved
18
E5
E6
9.1.2 Read Device Identification
There are multiple commands to read information about the device manufacturer, device type, and device features. SPI memories
from different vendors have used different commands and formats for reading information about the memories. The S25FL128S and
S25FL256S devices support the three most common device information commands.
9.1.3 Register Read or Write
There are multiple registers for reporting embedded operation status or controlling device configuration options. There are
commands for reading or writing these registers. Registers contain both volatile and non-volatile bits. Non-volatile bits in registers
are automatically erased and programmed as a single (write) operation.
9.1.3.1 Monitoring Operation Status
The host system can determine when a write, program, erase, suspend or other embedded operation is complete by monitoring the
Write in Progress (WIP) bit in the Status Register. The Read from Status Register-1 command provides the state of the WIP bit. The
program error (P_ERR) and erase error (E_ERR) bits in the status register indicate whether the most recent program or erase
command has not completed successfully. When P_ERR or E_ERR bits are set to one, the WIP bit will remain set to one indicating
the device remains busy. Under this condition, only the CLSR, WRDI, RDSR1, RDSR2, and software RESET commands are valid
commands. A Clear Status Register (CLSR) followed by a Write Disable (WRDI) command must be sent to return the device to
standby state. CLSR clears the WIP, P_ERR, and E_ERR bits. WRDI clears the WEL bit. Alternatively, Hardware Reset, or Software
Reset (RESET) may be used to return the device to standby state.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 69 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.1.3.2 Configuration
There are commands to read, write, and protect registers that control interface path width, interface timing, interface address length,
and some aspects of data protection.
9.1.4 Read Flash Array
Data may be read from the memory starting at any byte boundary. Data bytes are sequentially read from incrementally higher byte
addresses until the host ends the data transfer by driving CS# input High. If the byte address reaches the maximum address of the
memory array, the read will continue at address zero of the array.
There are several different read commands to specify different access latency and data path widths. Double Data Rate (DDR)
commands also define the address and data bit relationship to both SCK edges:
The Read command provides a single address bit per SCK rising edge on the SI signal with read data returning a single bit per
SCK falling edge on the SO signal. This command has zero latency between the address and the returning data but is limited to a
maximum SCK rate of 50 MHz.
Other read commands have a latency period between the address and returning data but can operate at higher SCK frequencies.
The latency depends on the configuration register latency code.
The Fast Read command provides a single address bit per SCK rising edge on the SI signal with read data returning a single bit
per SCK falling edge on the SO signal and may operate up to 133 MHz.
Dual or Quad Output read commands provide address a single bit per SCK rising edge on the SI / IO0 signal with read data
returning two bits, or four bits of data per SCK falling edge on the IO0-IO3 signals.
Dual or Quad I/O Read commands provide address two bits or four bits per SCK rising edge with read data returning two bits, or
four bits of data per SCK falling edge on the IO0-IO3 signals.
Fast (Single), Dual, or Quad Double Data Rate read commands provide address one bit, two bits or four bits per every SCK edge
with read data returning one bit, two bits, or four bits of data per every SCK edge on the IO0-IO3 signals. Double Data Rate (DDR)
operation is only supported for core and I/O voltages of 3 to 3.6V.
9.1.5 Program Flash Array
Programming data requires two commands: Write Enable (WREN), and Page Program (PP or QPP). The Page Program command
accepts from 1 byte up to 256 or 512 consecutive bytes of data (page) to be programmed in one operation. Programming means
that bits can either be left at 1, or programmed from 1 to 0. Changing bits from 0 to 1 requires an erase operation.
9.1.6 Erase Flash Array
The Sector Erase (SE) and Bulk Erase (BE) commands set all the bits in a sector or the entire memory array to 1. A bit needs to be
first erased to 1 before programming can change it to a 0. While bits can be individually programmed from a 1 to 0, erasing bits from
0 to 1 must be done on a sector-wide (SE) or array-wide (BE) level.
9.1.7 OTP, Block Protection, and Advanced Sector Protection
There are commands to read and program a separate One TIme Programmable (OTP) array for permanent data such as a serial
number. There are commands to control a contiguous group (block) of flash memory array sectors that are protected from program
and erase operations. There are commands to control which individual flash memory array sectors are protected from program and
erase operations.
9.1.8 Reset
There is a command to reset to the default conditions present after power on to the device. There is a command to reset (exit from)
the Enhanced Performance Read Modes.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 70 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.1.9 Reserved
Some instructions are reserved for future use. In this generation of the S25FL128S and S25FL256S some of these command
instructions may be unused and not affect device operation, some may have undefined results.
Some commands are reserved to ensure that a legacy or alternate source device command is allowed without affect. This allows
legacy software to issue some commands that are not relevant for the current generation S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices with
the assurance these commands do not cause some unexpected action.
Some commands are reserved for use in special versions of the FL-S not addressed by this document or for a future generation.
This allows new host memory controller designs to plan the flexibility to issue these command instructions. The command format is
defined if known at the time this document revision is published.
9.2
Identification Commands
9.2.1 Read Identification - REMS (Read_ID or REMS 90h)
The READ_ID command identifies the Device Manufacturer ID and the Device ID. The command is also referred to as Read
Electronic Manufacturer and device Signature (REMS). READ-ID (REMS) is only supported for backward compatibility and should
not be used for new software designs. New software designs should instead make use of the RDID command.
The command is initiated by shifting on SI the instruction code “90h” followed by a 24-bit address of 00000h. Following this, the
Manufacturer ID and the Device ID are shifted out on SO starting at the falling edge of SCK after address. The Manufacturer ID and
the Device ID are always shifted out with the MSB first. If the 24-bit address is set to 000001h, then the Device ID is read out first
followed by the Manufacturer ID. The Manufacturer ID and Device ID output data toggles between address 000000H and 000001H
until terminated by a low to high transition on CS# input. The maximum clock frequency for the READ_ID command is
133 MHz.
Figure 44. READ_ID Command Sequence
CS#
28 29 30 31
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
SCK
Instruction
90h
ADD (1)
23 22 21
MSB
3
2
1
0
SI
High Impedance
SO
CS
#
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
47
SCK
SI
Device ID
Manufacture ID
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 71 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 46. Read_ID Values
Device
Manufacturer ID (hex)
Device ID (hex)
01
01
17
18
S25FL128S
S25FL256S
9.2.2 Read Identification (RDID 9Fh)
The Read Identification (RDID) command provides read access to manufacturer identification, device identification, and Common
Flash Interface (CFI) information. The manufacturer identification is assigned by JEDEC. The CFI structure is defined by JEDEC
standard. The device identification and CFI values are assigned by Cypress.
The JEDEC Common Flash Interface (CFI) specification defines a device information structure, which allows a vendor-specified
software flash management program (driver) to be used for entire families of flash devices. Software support can then be device-
independent, JEDEC manufacturer ID independent, forward and backward-compatible for the specified flash device families.
System vendors can standardize their flash drivers for long-term software compatibility by using the CFI values to configure a family
driver from the CFI information of the device in use.
Any RDID command issued while a program, erase, or write cycle is in progress is ignored and has no effect on execution of the
program, erase, or write cycle that is in progress.
The RDID instruction is shifted on SI. After the last bit of the RDID instruction is shifted into the device, a byte of manufacturer
identification, two bytes of device identification, extended device identification, and CFI information will be shifted sequentially out on
SO. As a whole this information is referred to as ID-CFI. See Section 7.3 ID-CFI Address Space on page 46 for the detail description
of the ID-CFI contents.
Continued shifting of output beyond the end of the defined ID-CFI address space will provide undefined data. The RDID command
sequence is terminated by driving CS# to the logic high state anytime during data output.
The maximum clock frequency for the RDID command is 133 MHz.
Figure 9.1 Read Identification (RDID) Command Sequence
C S#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31
32
34
33
655
652 653 654
S CK
Instruction
SI
Extended Device Information
Manufacturer / Device Identification
High Impedance
644
645
646
1 647
0
1
2
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
SO
9.2.3 Read Electronic Signature (RES) (ABh)
The RES command is used to read a single byte Electronic Signature from SO. RES is only supported for backward compatibility
and should not be used for new software designs. New software designs should instead make use of the RDID command.
The RES instruction is shifted in followed by three dummy bytes onto SI. After the last bit of the three dummy bytes are shifted into
the device, a byte of Electronic Signature will be shifted out of SO. Each bit is shifted out by the falling edge of SCK. The maximum
clock frequency for the RES command is 50 MHz.
The Electronic Signature can be read repeatedly by applying multiples of eight clock cycles.
The RES command sequence is terminated by driving CS# to the logic high state anytime during data output.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 72 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 45. Read Electronic Signature (RES) Command Sequence
CS#
SCK
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
3 Dummy
Bytes
Instruction
23 22 21
MSB
3
2
1
0
SI
Electonic ID
High Impedance
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
MSB
Table 47. RES Values
Device
Device ID (hex)
S25FL128S
S25FL256S
17
18
9.3
Register Access Commands
9.3.1 Read Status Register-1 (RDSR1 05h)
The Read Status Register-1 (RDSR1) command allows the Status Register-1 contents to be read from SO. The Status Register-1
contents may be read at any time, even while a program, erase, or write operation is in progress. It is possible to read the Status
Register-1 continuously by providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The status is updated for each eight cycle read. The maximum
clock frequency for the RDSR1 (05h) command is 133 MHz.
Figure 9.2 Read Status Register-1 (RDSR1) Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
SCK
Instruction
SI
Status Register-1 Out
Status Register-1 Out
High Impedance
7
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
MSB
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 73 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.2 Read Status Register-2 (RDSR2 07h)
The Read Status Register (RDSR2) command allows the Status Register-2 contents to be read from SO. The Status Register-2
contents may be read at any time, even while a program, erase, or write operation is in progress. It is possible to read the Status
Register-2 continuously by providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The status is updated for each eight cycle read. The maximum
clock frequency for the RDSR2 command is 133 MHz.
Figure 9.3 Read Status Register-2 (RDSR2) Command
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Status Register-2 Out
Status Register-2 Out
High Impedance
7
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
MSB
MSB
MSB
9.3.3 Read Configuration Register (RDCR 35h)
The Read Configuration Register (RDCR) command allows the Configuration Register contents to be read from SO. It is possible to
read the Configuration Register continuously by providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The Configuration Register contents may
be read at any time, even while a program, erase, or write operation is in progress.
Figure 9.4 Read Configuration Register (RDCR) Command Sequence
CS#
SCK
SI
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Phase
Instruction
Register Read
Repeat Register Read
9.3.4 Bank Register Read (BRRD 16h)
The Read the Bank Register (BRRD) command allows the Bank address Register contents to be read from SO. The instruction is
first shifted in from SI. Then the 8-bit Bank Register is shifted out on SO. It is possible to read the Bank Register continuously by
providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The maximum operating clock frequency for the BRRD command is 133 MHz.
Figure 46. Read Bank Register (BRRD) Command
CSS##
0
11
22
33
44
55
66
77
88
99
1100
1111
1122
1133
14 15
1166
17 18
1199
2200
21 22
2233
SCCKK
Instruuccttiioonn
7
66
55
44
3
22
11
00
SI
MMSSBB
Bank Register OOuut
55 4
Bank Regiisstteer OOuutt
55 4
High Impedance
7
66
3
22
11
00
SO
7
66
3
22
11
00
7
MSB
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 74 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.5 Bank Register Write (BRWR 17h)
The Bank Register Write (BRWR) command is used to write address bits above A23, into the Bank Address Register (BAR). The
command is also used to write the Extended address control bit (EXTADD) that is also in BAR[7]. BAR provides the high order
addresses needed by devices having more than 128 Mbits (16 Mbytes), when using 3-byte address commands without extended
addressing enabled (BAR[7] EXTADD = 0). Because this command is part of the addressing method and is not changing data in the
flash memory, this command does not require the WREN command to precede it.
The BRWR instruction is entered, followed by the data byte on SI. The Bank Register is one data byte in length.
The BRWR command has no effect on the P_ERR, E_ERR or WIP bits of the Status and Configuration Registers. Any bank address
bit reserved for the future should always be written as a 0.
Figure 47. Bank Register Write (BRWR) Command
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13
Bank Register In
14
15
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.3.6 Bank Register Access (BRAC B9h)
The Bank Register Read and Write commands provide full access to the Bank Address Register (BAR) but they are both commands
that are not present in legacy SPI memory devices. Host system SPI memory controller interfaces may not be able to easily support
such new commands. The Bank Register Access (BRAC) command uses the same command code and format as the Deep Power
Down (DPD) command that is available in legacy SPI memories. The FL-S family does not support a DPD feature but assigns this
legacy command code to the BRAC command to enable write access to the Bank Address Register for legacy systems that are able
to send the legacy DPD (B9h) command.
When the BRAC command is sent, the FL-S family device will then interpret an immediately following Write Register (WRR)
command as a write to the lower address bits of the BAR. A WREN command is not used between the BRAC and WRR commands.
Only the lower two bits of the first data byte following the WRR command code are used to load BAR[1:0]. The upper bits of that byte
and the content of the optional WRR command second data byte are ignored. Following the WRR command the access to BAR is
closed and the device interface returns to the standby state. The combined BRAC followed by WRR command sequence has no
affect on the value of the ExtAdd bit (BAR[7]).
Commands other than WRR may immediately follow BRAC and execute normally. However, any command other than WRR, or any
other sequence in which CS# goes low and returns high, following a BRAC command, will close the access to BAR and return to the
normal interpretation of a WRR command as a write to Status Register-1 and the Configuration Register.
The BRAC + WRR sequence is allowed only when the device is in standby, program suspend, or erase suspend states. This
command sequence is illegal when the device is performing an embedded algorithm or when the program (P_ERR) or erase
(E_ERR) status bits are set to 1.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 75 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 48. BRAC (B9h) Command Sequence
CS#
SCK
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.3.7 Write Registers (WRR 01h)
The Write Registers (WRR) command allows new values to be written to both the Status Register-1 and Configuration Register.
Before the Write Registers (WRR) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be received.
After the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded successfully, the device will set the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the
Status Register to enable any write operations.
The Write Registers (WRR) command is entered by shifting the instruction and the data bytes on SI. The Status Register is one data
byte in length.
The Write Registers (WRR) command will set the P_ERR or E_ERR bits if there is a failure in the WRR operation. Any Status or
Configuration Register bit reserved for the future must be written as a 0.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the eighth or sixteenth bit of data has been latched. If not, the Write Registers (WRR)
command is not executed. If CS# is driven high after the eighth cycle then only the Status Register-1 is written; otherwise, after the
sixteenth cycle both the Status and Configuration Registers are written. When the configuration register QUAD bit CR[1] is 1, only
the WRR command format with 16 data bits may be used.
As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed Write Registers (WRR) operation is initiated. While the Write
Registers (WRR) operation is in progress, the Status Register may still be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit.
The Write-In Progress (WIP) bit is a 1 during the self-timed Write Registers (WRR) operation, and is a 0 when it is completed. When
the Write Registers (WRR) operation is completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) is set to a 0. The WRR command must be
executed under continuous power. The maximum clock frequency for the WRR command is 133 MHz.
Figure 49. Write Registers (WRR) Command Sequence – 8 data bits
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13
Status Register In
14 15
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 76 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 50. Write Registers (WRR) Command Sequence – 16 data bits
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13
Status Register In
14
15
16 17 18 19 20 21
Configuration Register In
22
23
SCK
Instruction
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
The Write Registers (WRR) command allows the user to change the values of the Block Protect (BP2, BP1, and BP0) bits to define
the size of the area that is to be treated as read-only. The Write Registers (WRR) command also allows the user to set the Status
Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit to a 1 or a 0. The Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit and Write Protect (WP#) signal allow
the BP bits to be hardware protected.
When the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit of the Status Register is a 0 (its initial delivery state), it is possible to write to the
Status Register provided that the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit has previously been set by a Write Enable (WREN) command,
regardless of the whether Write Protect (WP#) signal is driven to the logic high or logic low state.
When the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit of the Status Register is set to a 1, two cases need to be considered, depending
on the state of Write Protect (WP#):
If Write Protect (WP#) signal is driven to the logic high state, it is possible to write to the Status and Configuration Registers
provided that the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit has previously been set to a 1 by initiating a Write Enable (WREN) command.
If Write Protect (WP#) signal is driven to the logic low state, it is not possible to write to the Status and Configuration Registers
even if the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit has previously been set to a 1 by a Write Enable (WREN) command. Attempts to write to
the Status and Configuration Registers are rejected, and are not accepted for execution. As a consequence, all the data bytes in
the memory area that are protected by the Block Protect (BP2, BP1, BP0) bits of the Status Register, are also hardware protected
by WP#.
The WP# hardware protection can be provided:
by setting the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit after driving Write Protect (WP#) signal to the logic low state;
or by driving Write Protect (WP#) signal to the logic low state after setting the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit to a 1.
The only way to release the hardware protection is to pull the Write Protect (WP#) signal to the logic high state. If WP# is
permanently tied high, hardware protection of the BP bits can never be activated.
Table 48. Block Protection Modes
Memory Content
Protected Area Unprotected Area
WP#
SRWD Bit
Mode
Write Protection of Registers
1
1
0
1
0
0
Status and Configuration Registers are Writable (if
Protected against Page Ready to accept Page
Software Pro-
tected
WREN command has set the WEL bit). The values in Program, Quad Input
the SRWD, BP2, BP1, and BP0 bits and those in the Program, Sector
Program, Quad Input
Program and Sector
Configuration Register can be changed
Erase, and Bulk Erase Erase commands
Status and Configuration Registers are Hardware
Write Protected. The values in the SRWD, BP2, BP1,
and BP0 bits and those in the Configuration Register
cannot be changed
Protected against Page Ready to accept Page
Hardware
Protected
0
1
Program, Sector
Program or Erase
Erase, and Bulk Erase commands
Notes:
1. The Status Register originally shows 00h when the device is first shipped from Cypress to the customer.
2. Hardware protection is disabled when Quad Mode is enabled (QUAD bit = 1 in Configuration Register). WP# becomes IO2; therefore, it cannot be utilized.
The WRR command has an alternate function of loading the Bank Address Register if the command immediately follows a BRAC
command. See Section 9.3.6 Bank Register Access (BRAC B9h) on page 75.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 77 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.8 Write Enable (WREN 06h)
The Write Enable (WREN) command sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit of the Status Register 1 (SR1[1]) to a 1. The Write
Enable Latch (WEL) bit must be set to a 1 by issuing the Write Enable (WREN) command to enable write, program and erase
commands.
CS# must be driven into the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction byte has been latched in on SI. Without CS# being
driven to the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction byte has been latched in on SI, the write enable operation will not
be executed.
Figure 51. Write Enable (WREN) Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction
SI
9.3.9 Write Disable (WRDI 04h)
The Write Disable (WRDI) command sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit of the Status Register-1 (SR1[1]) to a 0.
The Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit may be set to a 0 by issuing the Write Disable (WRDI) command to disable Page Program (PP),
Sector Erase (SE), Bulk Erase (BE), Write Registers (WRR), OTP Program (OTPP), and other commands, that require WEL be set
to 1 for execution. The WRDI command can be used by the user to protect memory areas against inadvertent writes that can
possibly corrupt the contents of the memory. The WRDI command is ignored during an embedded operation while WIP bit =1.
CS# must be driven into the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction byte has been latched in on SI. Without CS# being
driven to the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction byte has been latched in on SI, the write disable operation will not
be executed.
Figure 52. Write Disable (WRDI) Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
SI
Instruction
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 78 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.10 Clear Status Register (CLSR 30h)
The Clear Status Register command resets bit SR1[5] (Erase Fail Flag) and bit SR1[6] (Program Fail Flag). It is not necessary to set
the WEL bit before the Clear SR command is executed. The Clear SR command will be accepted even when the device remains
busy with WIP set to 1, as the device does remain busy when either error bit is set. The WEL bit will be unchanged after this
command is executed.
Figure 53. Clear Status Register (CLSR) Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
SI
Instruction
9.3.11 ECC Status Register Read (ECCRD 18h)
To read the ECC Status Register, the command is followed by the ECC unit (32 bit) address, the four least significant bits (LSB) of
address must be set to zero. This is followed by eight dummy cycles. Then the 8-bit contents of the ECC Register, for the ECC unit
selected, are shifted out on SO 16 times, once for each byte in the ECC Unit. If CS# remains low the next ECC unit status is sent
through SO 16 times, once for each byte in the ECC Unit, this continues until CS# goes high. The maximum operating clock
frequency for the ECC READ command is 133 MHz. See Section 9.5.1.1 Automatic ECC on page 100 for details on ECC unit.
Figure 54. ECC Status Register Read Command Sequence
CS#
0
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
SCK
32-Bit
Instruction
Dummy Byte
Address
SI
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 79 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.12 AutoBoot
SPI devices normally require 32 or more cycles of command and address shifting to initiate a read command. And, in order to read
boot code from an SPI device, the host memory controller or processor must supply the read command from a hardwired state
machine or from some host processor internal ROM code.
Parallel NOR devices need only an initial address, supplied in parallel in a single cycle, and initial access time to start reading boot
code.
The AutoBoot feature allows the host memory controller to take boot code from an S25FL128S and S25FL256S device immediately
after the end of reset, without having to send a read command. This saves 32 or more cycles and simplifies the logic needed to
initiate the reading of boot code.
As part of the power up reset, hardware reset, or command reset process the AutoBoot feature automatically starts a read access
from a pre-specified address. At the time the reset process is completed, the device is ready to deliver code from the starting
address. The host memory controller only needs to drive CS# signal from high to low and begin toggling the SCK signal. The
S25FL128S and S25FL256S device will delay code output for a pre-specified number of clock cycles before code streams out.
– The Auto Boot Start Delay (ABSD) field of the AutoBoot register specifies the initial delay if any is needed by the host.
– The host cannot send commands during this time.
If ABSD = 0, the maximum SCK frequency is 50 MHz.
– If ABSD > 0, the maximum SCK frequency is 133 MHz if the QUAD bit CR1[1] is 0 or 104 MHz if the QUAD bit is set to 1.
The starting address of the boot code is selected by the value programmed into the AutoBoot Start Address (ABSA) field of the
AutoBoot Register which specifies a 512-byte boundary aligned location; the default address is 00000000h.
– Data will continuously shift out until CS# returns high.
At any point after the first data byte is transferred, when CS# returns high, the SPI device will reset to standard SPI mode; able to
accept normal command operations.
– A minimum of one byte must be transferred.
– AutoBoot mode will not initiate again until another power cycle or a reset occurs.
An AutoBoot Enable bit (ABE) is set to enable the AutoBoot feature.
The AutoBoot register bits are non-volatile and provide:
The starting address (512-byte boundary), set by the AutoBoot Start Address (ABSA). The size of the ABSA field is 23 bits for
devices up to 32-Gbit.
The number of initial delay cycles, set by the AutoBoot Start Delay (ABSD) 8-bit count value.
The AutoBoot Enable.
If the configuration register QUAD bit CR1[1] is set to 1, the boot code will be provided 4 bits per cycle in the same manner as a
Read Quad Out command. If the QUAD bit is 0 the code is delivered serially in the same manner as a Read command.
Figure 55. AutoBoot Sequence (CR1[1]=0)
CS#
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
n
n+1 n+2 n+3 n+4 n+5 n+6 n+7 n+8 n+9
SCK
Wait State
tWS
Don’t Care or High Impedance
SI
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
SO
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 80 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 56. AutoBoot Sequence (CR1[1]=1)
CS#
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
n
n+1 n+2 n+3 n+4 n+5 n+6 n+7 n+8 n+9
SCK
IO0
Wait State
tWS
High Impedance
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
DATA OUT 1
High Impedance
High Impedance
5
6
1
2
5
6
1
5
1
5
6
1
2
5
6
IO1
IO2
2
6
2
High Impedance
IO3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
MSB
9.3.13 AutoBoot Register Read (ABRD 14h)
The AutoBoot Register Read command is shifted into SI. Then the 32-bit AutoBoot Register is shifted out on SO, least significant
byte first, most significant bit of each byte first. It is possible to read the AutoBoot Register continuously by providing multiples of 32
clock cycles. If the QUAD bit CR1[1] is cleared to 0, the maximum operating clock frequency for ABRD command is 133 MHz. If the
QUAD bit CR1[1] is set to 1, the maximum operating clock frequency for ABRD command is 104 MHz.
Figure 57. AutoBoot Register Read (ABRD) Command
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11
37 38 39 40
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
AutoBoot Register
26 25 24
High Impedance
7
7
6
5
4
SO
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 81 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.14 AutoBoot Register Write (ABWR 15h)
Before the ABWR command can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the device, which
sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to enable any write operations.
The ABWR command is entered by shifting the instruction and the data bytes on SI, least significant byte first, most significant bit of
each byte first. The ABWR data is 32 bits in length.
The ABWR command has status reported in Status Register-1 as both an erase and a programming operation. An E_ERR or a
P_ERR may be set depending on whether the erase or programming phase of updating the register fails.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the 32nd bit of data has been latched. If not, the ABWR command is not executed.
As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed ABWR operation is initiated. While the ABWR operation is in
progress, Status Register-1 may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In Progress (WIP) bit is a
1 during the self-timed ABWR operation, and is a 0. when it is completed. When the ABWR cycle is completed, the Write Enable
Latch (WEL) is set to a 0. The maximum clock frequency for the ABWR command is 133 MHz.
Figure 58. AutoBoot Register Write (ABWR) Command
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37
38
39
SCK
Instruction
AutoBoot Register
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
27
26
25
24
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.3.15 Program NVDLR (PNVDLR 43h)
Before the Program NVDLR (PNVDLR) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be
issued and decoded by the device. After the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded successfully, the device will set the
Write Enable Latch (WEL) to enable the PNVDLR operation.
The PNVDLR command is entered by shifting the instruction and the data byte on SI.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the eighth (8th) bit of data has been latched. If not, the PNVDLR command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed PNVDLR operation is initiated. While the PNVDLR
operation is in progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In
Progress (WIP) bit is a 1 during the self-timed PNVDLR cycle, and is a 0. when it is completed. The PNVDLR operation can report a
program error in the P_ERR bit of the status register. When the PNVDLR operation is completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) is
set to a 0 The maximum clock frequency for the PNVDLR command is 133 MHz.
Figure 59. Program NVDLR (PNVDLR) Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
13
14
15
11
SCK
Instruction
Data Learning Pattern
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
M SB
M SB
High Im pedance
SO
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 82 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.3.16 Write VDLR (WVDLR 4Ah)
Before the Write VDLR (WVDLR) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and
decoded by the device. After the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded successfully, the device will set the Write
Enable Latch (WEL) to enable WVDLR operation.
The WVDLR command is entered by shifting the instruction and the data byte on SI.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the eighth (8th) bit of data has been latched. If not, the WVDLR command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the WVDLR operation is initiated with no delays. The maximum clock
frequency for the PNVDLR command is 133 MHz.
Figure 60. Write VDLR (WVDLR) Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12 13
14
15
11
SCK
Instruction
Data Learning Pattern
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.3.17 Data Learning Pattern Read (DLPRD 41h)
The instruction is shifted on SI, then the 8-bit DLP is shifted out on SO. It is possible to read the DLP continuously by providing
multiples of eight clock cycles. The maximum operating clock frequency for the DLPRD command is 133 MHz.
Figure 9.5 DLP Read (DLPRD) Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12 13
14
15
16 17 18
20 21
22
23
11
19
SCK
Instruction
Data Learning Pattern
Data Learning Pattern
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 83 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4
Read Memory Array Commands
Read commands for the main flash array provide many options for prior generation SPI compatibility or enhanced performance SPI:
Some commands transfer address or data on each rising edge of SCK. These are called Single Data Rate commands (SDR).
Some SDR commands transfer address one bit per rising edge of SCK and return data 1, 2, or 4 bits of data per rising edge of
SCK. These are called Read or Fast Read for 1-bit data; Dual Output Read for 2-bit data, and Quad Output for 4-bit data.
Some SDR commands transfer both address and data 2 or 4 bits per rising edge of SCK. These are called Dual I/O for 2 bit and
Quad I/O for 4 bit.
Some commands transfer address and data on both the rising edge and falling edge of SCK. These are called Double Data Rate
(DDR) commands.
There are DDR commands for 1, 2, or 4 bits of address or data per SCK edge. These are called Fast DDR for 1-bit, Dual I/O DDR
for 2-bit, and Quad I/O DDR for 4-bit per edge transfer.
All of these commands begin with an instruction code that is transferred one bit per SCK rising edge. The instruction is followed by
either a 3- or 4-byte address transferred at SDR or DDR. Commands transferring address or data 2 or 4 bits per clock edge are
called Multiple I/O (MIO) commands. For FL-S devices at
256 Mbits or higher density, the traditional SPI 3-byte addresses are unable to directly address all locations in the memory array.
These device have a bank address register that is used with 3-byte address commands to supply the high order address bits beyond
the address from the host system. The default bank address is zero. Commands are provided to load and read the bank address
register. These devices may also be configured to take a 4-byte address from the host system with the traditional 3-byte address
commands. The 4-byte address mode for traditional commands is activated by setting the External Address (EXTADD) bit in the
bank address register to 1. In the FL128S, higher order address bits above A23 in the 4-byte address commands, commands using
Extended Address mode, and the Bank Address Register are not relevant and are ignored because the flash array is only 128 Mbits
in size.
The Quad I/O commands provide a performance improvement option controlled by mode bits that are sent following the address
bits. The mode bits indicate whether the command following the end of the current read will be another read of the same type,
without an instruction at the beginning of the read. These mode bits give the option to eliminate the instruction cycles when doing a
series of Quad I/O read accesses.
A device ordering option provides an enhanced high performance option by adding a similar mode bit scheme to the DDR Fast
Read, Dual I/O, and Dual I/O DDR commands, in addition to the Quad I/O command.
Some commands require delay cycles following the address or mode bits to allow time to access the memory array. The delay
cycles are traditionally called dummy cycles. The dummy cycles are ignored by the memory thus any data provided by the host
during these cycles is “don’t care” and the host may also leave the SI signal at high impedance during the dummy cycles. When MIO
commands are used the host must stop driving the IO signals (outputs are high impedance) before the end of last dummy cycle.
When DDR commands are used the host must not drive the I/O signals during any dummy cycle. The number of dummy cycles
varies with the SCK frequency or performance option selected via the Configuration Register 1 (CR1) Latency Code (LC). Dummy
cycles are measured from SCK falling edge to next SCK falling edge. SPI outputs are traditionally driven to a new value on the falling
edge of each SCK. Zero dummy cycles means the returning data is driven by the memory on the same falling edge of SCK that the
host stops driving address or mode bits.
The DDR commands may optionally have an 8-edge Data Learning Pattern (DLP) driven by the memory, on all data outputs, in the
dummy cycles immediately before the start of data. The DLP can help the host memory controller determine the phase shift from
SCK to data edges so that the memory controller can capture data at the center of the data eye.
When using SDR I/O commands at higher SCK frequencies (>50 MHz), an LC that provides 1 or more dummy cycles should be
selected to allow additional time for the host to stop driving before the memory starts driving data, to minimize I/O driver conflict.
When using DDR I/O commands with the DLP enabled, an LC that provides 5 or more dummy cycles should be selected to allow 1
cycle of additional time for the host to stop driving before the memory starts driving the 4 cycle DLP.
Each read command ends when CS# is returned High at any point during data return. CS# must not be returned High during the
mode or dummy cycles before data returns as this may cause mode bits to be captured incorrectly; making it indeterminate as to
whether the device remains in enhanced high performance read mode.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 84 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4.1 Read (Read 03h or 4READ 13h)
The instruction
03h (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
03h (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
13h is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
Then the memory contents, at the address given, are shifted out on SO. The maximum operating clock frequency for the READ
command is 50 MHz.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
Figure 9.6 Read Command Sequence (3-byte Address, 03h [ExtAdd=0])
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
SCK
24-Bit
Address
Instruction
23 22 21
3
2
1
0
SI
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
SO
MSB
MSB
Figure 9.7 Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 13h or 03h [ExtAdd=1])
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
SI
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
SO
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 85 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4.2 Fast Read (FAST_READ 0Bh or 4FAST_READ 0Ch)
The instruction
0Bh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
0Bh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
0Ch is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
The address is followed by zero or eight dummy cycles depending on the latency code set in the Configuration Register. The dummy
cycles allow the device internal circuits additional time for accessing the initial address location. During the dummy cycles the data
value on SO is “don’t care” and may be high impedance. Then the memory contents, at the address given, are shifted out on SO.
The maximum operating clock frequency for FAST READ command is 133 MHz.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
Figure 9.8 Fast Read (FAST_READ) Command Sequence (3-byte Address, 0Bh [ExtAdd=0, LC=10b])
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
24-Bit
Address
Instruction
Dummy Byte
SI
23 22 21
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
MSB
Figure 9.9 Fast Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 0Ch or 0B [ExtAdd=1], LC=10b)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
SCK
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
Dummy Byte
SI
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
MSB
Figure 9.10 Fast Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 0Ch or 0B [ExtAdd=1], LC=11b)
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
SCK
Instruction
32 Bit Address
1
Data 1
Data 2
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31
0
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 86 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4.3 Dual Output Read (DOR 3Bh or 4DOR 3Ch)
The instruction
3Bh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
3Bh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
3Ch is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
Then the memory contents, at the address given, is shifted out two bits at a time through IO0 (SI) and IO1 (SO). Two bits are shifted
out at the SCK frequency by the falling edge of the SCK signal.
The maximum operating clock frequency for the Dual Output Read command is 104 MHz. For Dual Output Read commands, there
are zero or eight dummy cycles required after the last address bit is shifted into SI before data begins shifting out of IO0 and IO1.
This latency period (i.e., dummy cycles) allows the device’s internal circuitry enough time to read from the initial address. During the
dummy cycles, the data value on SI is a “don’t care” and may be high impedance. The number of dummy cycles is determined by the
frequency of SCK (refer to Table 28, Latency Codes for SDR Enhanced High Performance on page 51).
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
Figure 9.11 Dual Output Read Command Sequence (3-byte Address, 3Bh [ExtAdd=0], LC=10b)
CS#
SCK
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
23 22 21
Address
0
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Phase
Instruction
8 Dummy Cycles
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 9.12 Dual Output Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 3Ch or 3Bh [ExtAdd=1, LC=10b])
CS#
SCK
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
Address
0
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Phase
Instruction
8 Dummy Cycles
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 61. Dual Output Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 3Ch or 3Bh [ExtAdd=1, LC=11b])
CS#
SCK
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
Address
0
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Phase
Instruction
Data 1
Data 2
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 87 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4.4 Quad Output Read (QOR 6Bh or 4QOR 6Ch)
The instruction
6Bh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
6Bh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
6Ch is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
Then the memory contents, at the address given, is shifted out four bits at a time through IO0-IO3. Each nibble (4 bits) is shifted out
at the SCK frequency by the falling edge of the SCK signal.
The maximum operating clock frequency for Quad Output Read command is 104 MHz. For Quad Output Read Mode, there may be
dummy cycles required after the last address bit is shifted into SI before data begins shifting out of IO0-IO3. This latency period (i.e.,
dummy cycles) allows the device’s internal circuitry enough time to set up for the initial address. During the dummy cycles, the data
value on IO0-IO3 is a “don’t care” and may be high impedance. The number of dummy cycles is determined by the frequency of SCK
(refer to Table 28, Latency Codes for SDR Enhanced High Performance on page 51).
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
The QUAD bit of Configuration Register must be set (CR Bit1=1) to enable the Quad mode capability.
Figure 9.13 Quad Output Read Command Sequence (3-byte Address, 6Bh [ExtAdd=0, LC=01b])
CS#
0
7
1
6
2
5
3
4
5
2
6
1
7
0
8
30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
SCK
Instruction
24 Bit Address
23
8 Dummy Cycles
Data 1
Data 2
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
3
1
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
Figure 9.14 Quad Output Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 6Ch or 6Bh [ExtAdd=1, LC=01b])
CS#
SCK
0
7
1
6
2
5
3
4
5
2
6
1
7
0
8
38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51
Instruction
32 Bit Address
31
8 Dummy Cycles
Data 1
Data 2
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
3
1
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 88 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 9.15 Quad Output Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 6Ch or 6Bh [ExtAdd=1], LC=11b)
CS#
SCK
0
7
1
6
2
5
3
4
5
2
6
1
7
0
8
38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
Instruction
32 Bit Address
1
Data 1
Data 2
Data 3
Data 3
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
3
31
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
9.4.5 Dual I/O Read (DIOR BBh or 4DIOR BCh)
The instruction
BBh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
BBh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
BCh is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
The Dual I/O Read commands improve throughput with two I/O signals — IO0 (SI) and IO1 (SO). It is similar to the Dual Output
Read command but takes input of the address two bits per SCK rising edge. In some applications, the reduced address input time
might allow for code execution in place (XIP) i.e. directly from the memory device.
The maximum operating clock frequency for Dual I/O Read is 104 MHz.
For the Dual I/O Read command, there is a latency required after the last address bits are shifted into SI and SO before data begins
shifting out of IO0 and IO1. There are different ordering part numbers that select the latency code table used for this command,
either the High Performance LC (HPLC) table or the Enhanced High Performance LC (EHPLC) table. The HPLC table does not
provide cycles for mode bits so each Dual I/O Read command starts with the 8 bit instruction, followed by address, followed by a
latency period.
This latency period (dummy cycles) allows the device internal circuitry enough time to access data at the initial address. During the
dummy cycles, the data value on SI and SO are “don’t care” and may be high impedance. The number of dummy cycles is
determined by the frequency of SCK (see Table 28 on page 51). The number of dummy cycles is set by the LC bits in the
Configuration Register (CR1).
The EHPLC table does provide cycles for mode bits so a series of Dual I/O Read commands may eliminate the 8-bit instruction after
the first Dual I/O Read command sends a mode bit pattern of Axh that indicates the following command will also be a Dual I/O Read
command. The first Dual I/O Read command in a series starts with the 8-bit instruction, followed by address, followed by four cycles
of mode bits, followed by a latency period. If the mode bit pattern is Axh the next command is assumed to be an additional Dual I/O
Read command that does not provide instruction bits. That command starts with address, followed by mode bits, followed by
latency.
The Enhanced High Performance feature removes the need for the instruction sequence and greatly improves code execution (XIP).
The upper nibble (bits 7-4) of the Mode bits control the length of the next Dual I/O Read command through the inclusion or exclusion
of the first byte instruction code. The lower nibble (bits 3-0) of the Mode bits are “don’t care” (“x”) and may be high impedance. If the
Mode bits equal Axh, then the device remains in Dual I/O Enhanced High Performance Read Mode and the next address can be
entered (after CS# is raised high and then asserted low) without the BBh or BCh instruction, as shown in Figure 63; thus, eliminating
eight cycles for the command sequence. The following sequence will release the device from Dual I/O Enhanced High Performance
Read mode; after which, the device can accept standard SPI commands:
During the Dual I/O Enhanced High Performance Command Sequence, if the Mode bits are any value other than Axh, then the
next time CS# is raised high the device will be released from Dual
I/O Read Enhanced High Performance Read mode.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 89 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
During any operation, if CS# toggles high to low to high for eight cycles (or less) and data input (IO0 and IO1) are not set for a valid
instruction sequence, then the device will be released from Dual I/O Enhanced High Performance Read mode. Note that the four
mode bit cycles are part of the device’s internal circuitry latency time to access the initial address after the last address cycle that is
clocked into IO0 (SI) and IO1 (SO).
It is important that the I/O signals be set to high-impedance at or before the falling edge of the first data out clock. At higher clock
speeds the time available to turn off the host outputs before the memory device begins to drive (bus turn around) is diminished. It is
allowed and may be helpful in preventing I/O signal contention, for the host system to turn off the I/O signal outputs (make them high
impedance) during the last two “don’t care” mode cycles or during any dummy cycles.
Following the latency period the memory content, at the address given, is shifted out two bits at a time through IO0 (SI) and IO1
(SO). Two bits are shifted out at the SCK frequency at the falling edge of SCK signal.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
CS# should not be driven high during mode or dummy bits as this may make the mode bits indeterminate.
Figure 62. Dual I/O Read Command Sequence (3-byte Address, BBh [ExtAdd=0], HPLC=00b)
CS#
SCK
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
22 20 18
23 21 19
Address
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Phase
Instruction
4 Dummy
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 9.16 Dual I/O Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, BBh [ExtAdd=1], HPLC=10b)
CS#
SCK
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
30 28 26
31 29 27
Address
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Phase
Instruction
6 Dummy
Data 1
Data 2
Figure 9.17 Dual I/O Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, BCh or BBh [ExtAdd=1], EHPLC=10b)
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
SCK
8 cycles
Instruction
16 cycles
32 Bit Address
4 cycles
Mode
2 cycles
Dummy
4 cycles
Data 1
Data 2
2
4
0
1
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
30
31
2
3
0
1
6
7
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
3
5
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 90 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 63. Continuous Dual I/O Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address, BCh or BBh [ExtAdd=1], EHPLC=10b)
CS#
0
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
SCK
4 cycles
Data N
16 cycles
32 Bit Address
4 cycles
Mode
2 cycles
Dummy
4 cycles
Data 1
4 cycles
Data 2
2
4
0
1
IO0
IO1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
30
31
2
3
0
1
6
7
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
3
5
9.4.6 Quad I/O Read (QIOR EBh or 4QIOR ECh)
The instruction
EBh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
EBh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
ECh is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
The Quad I/O Read command improves throughput with four I/O signals — IO0-IO3. It is similar to the Quad Output Read command
but allows input of the address bits four bits per serial SCK clock. In some applications, the reduced instruction overhead might allow
for code execution (XIP) directly from S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices. The QUAD bit of the Configuration Register must be set
(CR Bit1=1) to enable the Quad capability of S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices.
The maximum operating clock frequency for Quad I/O Read is 104 MHz.
For the Quad I/O Read command, there is a latency required after the mode bits (described below) before data begins shifting out of
IO0-IO3. This latency period (i.e., dummy cycles) allows the device’s internal circuitry enough time to access data at the initial
address. During latency cycles, the data value on IO0-IO3 are “don’t care” and may be high impedance. The number of dummy
cycles is determined by the frequency of SCK and the latency code table (refer to Table 28 on page 51). There are different ordering
part numbers that select the latency code table used for this command, either the High Performance LC (HPLC) table or the
Enhanced High Performance LC (EHPLC) table. The number of dummy cycles is set by the LC bits in the Configuration Register
(CR1). However, both latency code tables use the same latency values for the Quad I/O Read command.
Following the latency period, the memory contents at the address given, is shifted out four bits at a time through IO0-IO3. Each
nibble (4 bits) is shifted out at the SCK frequency by the falling edge of the SCK signal.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
Address jumps can be done without the need for additional Quad I/O Read instructions. This is controlled through the setting of the
Mode bits (after the address sequence, as shown in Figure 9.18 on page 92 or Figure 9.20 on page 92). This added feature
removes the need for the instruction sequence and greatly improves code execution (XIP). The upper nibble (bits 7-4) of the Mode
bits control the length of the next Quad I/O instruction through the inclusion or exclusion of the first byte instruction code. The lower
nibble (bits 3-0) of the Mode bits are “don’t care” (“x”). If the Mode bits equal Axh, then the device remains in Quad I/O High
Performance Read Mode and the next address can be entered (after CS# is raised high and then asserted low) without requiring the
EBh or ECh instruction, as shown in Figure 9.19 on page 92 or Figure 9.21 on page 93; thus, eliminating eight cycles for the
command sequence. The following sequence will release the device from Quad I/O High Performance Read mode; after which, the
device can accept standard SPI commands:
During the Quad I/O Read Command Sequence, if the Mode bits are any value other than Axh, then the next time CS# is raised
high the device will be released from Quad I/O High Performance Read mode.
During any operation, if CS# toggles high to low to high for eight cycles (or less) and data input (IO0-IO3) are not set for a valid
instruction sequence, then the device will be released from Quad I/O High Performance Read mode. Note that the two mode bit
clock cycles and additional wait states (i.e., dummy cycles) allow the device’s internal circuitry latency time to access the initial
address after the last address cycle that is clocked into IO0-IO3.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 91 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
It is important that the IO0-IO3 signals be set to high-impedance at or before the falling edge of the first data out clock. At higher
clock speeds the time available to turn off the host outputs before the memory device begins to drive (bus turn around) is diminished.
It is allowed and may be helpful in preventing IO0-IO3 signal contention, for the host system to turn off the IO0-IO3 signal outputs
(make them high impedance) during the last “don’t care” mode cycle or during any dummy cycles.
CS# should not be driven high during mode or dummy bits as this may make the mode bits indeterminate.
Figure 9.18 Quad I/O Read Command Sequence (3-byte Address, EBh [ExtAdd=0], LC=00b)
CS#
0
7
1
6
2
5
3
4
5
2
6
1
7
0
8
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
SCK
8 cycles
Instruction
6 cycles
24 Bit Address
2 cycles
Mode
4 cycles
Dummy
2 cycles
Data 1
Data 2
0
4
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
3
20
21
22
23
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
5
2
6
3
7
Figure 9.19 Continuous Quad I/O Read Command Sequence (3-byte Address), LC=00b
CS#
SCK
0
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
2 cycles
Data N
2 cycles
Data N+1
6 cycles
24 Bit Address
2 cycles
Mode
4 cycles
Dummy
2 cycles
Data 1
2 cycles
Data 2
0
4
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
5
6
7
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
20
21
22
23
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
5
1
2
3
2
6
3
7
Figure 9.20 Quad I/O Read Command Sequence(4-byte Address, ECh or EBh [ExtAdd=1], LC=00b)
CS#
SCK
0
7
1
6
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
8 cycles
Instruction
8 cycles
32 Bit Address
2 cycles
Mode
4 cycles
Dummy
2 cycles
Data 1
Data 2
0
4
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
5
4
3
2
1
0
28
29
30
31
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
5
2
6
3
7
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 92 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 9.21 Continuous Quad I/O Read Command Sequence (4-byte Address), LC=00b
CS#
SCK
0
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
2 cycles
Data N
2 cycles
Data N+1
8 cycles
32 Bit Address
2 cycles
Mode
4 cycles
Dummy
2 cycles
Data 1
2 cycles
Data 2
0
4
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
5
6
7
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
28
29
30
31
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
5
1
2
3
2
6
3
7
9.4.7 DDR Fast Read (DDRFR 0Dh, 4DDRFR 0Eh)
The instruction
0Dh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
0Dh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
0Eh is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
The DDR Fast Read command improves throughput by transferring address and data on both the falling and rising edge of SCK. It
is similar to the Fast Read command but allows transfer of address and data on every edge of the clock.
The maximum operating clock frequency for DDR Fast Read command is 80 MHz.
For the DDR Fast Read command, there is a latency required after the last address bits are shifted into SI before data begins
shifting out of SO. There are different ordering part numbers that select the latency code table used for this command, either the
High Performance LC (HPLC) table or the Enhanced High Performance LC (EHPLC) table. The HPLC table does not provide cycles
for mode bits so each DDR Fast Read command starts with the 8 bit instruction, followed by address, followed by a latency period.
This latency period (dummy cycles) allows the device internal circuitry enough time to access data at the initial address. During the
dummy cycles, the data value on SI is “don’t care” and may be high impedance. The number of dummy cycles is determined by the
frequency of SCK (Table 28 on page 51). The number of dummy cycles is set by the LC bits in the Configuration Register (CR1).
Then the memory contents, at the address given, is shifted out, in DDR fashion, one bit at a time on each clock edge through SO.
Each bit is shifted out at the SCK frequency by the rising and falling edge of the SCK signal.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
The EHPLC table does provide cycles for mode bits so a series of DDR Fast Read commands may eliminate the 8 bit instruction
after the first DDR Fast Read command sends a mode bit pattern of complementary first and second Nibbles, e.g. A5h, 5Ah, 0Fh,
etc., that indicates the following command will also be a DDR Fast Read command. The first DDR Fast Read command in a series
starts with the 8-bit instruction, followed by address, followed by four cycles of mode bits, followed by a latency period. If the mode
bit pattern is complementary the next command is assumed to be an additional DDR Fast Read command that does not provide
instruction bits. That command starts with address, followed by mode bits, followed by latency.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 93 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
When the EHPLC table is used, address jumps can be done without the need for additional DDR Fast Read instructions. This is
controlled through the setting of the Mode bits (after the address sequence, as shown in Figure 9.22 on page 94 and Figure 9.24
on page 95. This added feature removes the need for the eight bit SDR instruction sequence to reduce initial access time (improves
XIP performance). The Mode bits control the length of the next DDR Fast Read operation through the inclusion or exclusion of the
first byte instruction code. If the upper nibble (IO[7:4]) and lower nibble (IO[3:0]) of the Mode bits are complementary (i.e. 5h and Ah)
then the next address can be entered (after CS# is raised high and then asserted low) without requiring the 0Dh or 0Eh instruction,
as shown in Figure 9.23 and Figure 9.25, thus, eliminating eight cycles from the command sequence. The following sequences will
release the device from this continuous DDR Fast Read mode; after which, the device can accept standard SPI commands:
1. During the DDR Fast Read Command Sequence, if the Mode bits are not complementary the next time CS# is raised high
the device will be released from the continuous DDR Fast Read mode.
2. During any operation, if CS# toggles high to low to high for eight cycles (or less) and data input (SI) are not set for a valid
instruction sequence, then the device will be released from DDR Fast Read mode.
CS# should not be driven high during mode or dummy bits as this may make the mode bits indeterminate.
The HOLD function is not valid during any part of a Fast DDR Command.
Although the data learning pattern (DLP) is programmable, the following example shows example of the DLP of 34h. The DLP 34h
(or 00110100) will be driven on each of the active outputs (i.e. all four IOs on a x4 device, both IOs on a x2 device and the single SO
output on a x1 device). This pattern was chosen to cover both DC and AC data transition scenarios. The two DC transition scenarios
include data low for a long period of time (two half clocks) followed by a high going transition (001) and the complementary low going
transition (110). The two AC transition scenarios include data low for a short period of time (one half clock) followed by a high going
transition (101) and the complementary low going transition (010). The DC transitions will typically occur with a starting point closer
to the supply rail than the AC transitions that may not have fully settled to their steady state (DC) levels. In many cases the DC
transitions will bound the beginning of the data valid period and the AC transitions will bound the ending of the data valid period.
These transitions will allow the host controller to identify the beginning and ending of the valid data eye. Once the data eye has been
characterized the optimal data capture point can be chosen. See Section 7.5.12 SPI DDR Data Learning Registers on page 56 for
more details.
Figure 9.22 DDR Fast Read Initial Access (3-byte Address, 0Dh [ExtAdd=0, EHPLC=11b])
CS#
0
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
SCK
8 cycles
Instruction
12 cycles
24 Bit Address
4 cycles
Mode
1 cyc
Dummy
4 cycles
per data
IO0
IO1
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
2
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
Figure 9.23 Continuous DDR Fast Read Subsequent Access (3-byte Address [ExtAdd=0, EHPLC=11b])
CS#
0
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
SCK
12 cycles
24 Bit Address
4 cycles
Mode
1 cyc
Dummy
4 cycles
per data
IO0
IO1
23 2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 94 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 9.24 DDR Fast Read Initial Access (4-byte Address, 0Eh or 0Dh [ExtAdd=1], EHPLC=01b)
CS#
SCK
0
1
6
2
5
3
4
5
2
6
1
7
0
8
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
8 cycles
Instruction
16 cycles
32b Add
4 cycles
Mode
4 cycles Dummy
Optional DLP
4 cycles
per data
SI
7
4
3
31
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
Note:
1. Example DLP of 34h (or 00110100).
Figure 9.25 Continuous DDR Fast Read Subsequent Access (4-byte Address [ExtAdd=1], EHPLC=01b)
CS#
SCK
0
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
16 cycles
32b Add
4 cycles
Mode
4 cycles Dummy
Optional DLP
4 cycles
per data
SI
31
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
Note:
1. Example DLP of 34h (or 00110100).
Figure 9.26 DDR Fast Read Subsequent Access (4-byte Address, HPLC=01b)
CS#
SCK
0
1
6
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
8 cycles
16 cycles
32b Add
6 cycles
Dummy
4 cycles
per data
Instruction
SI
7
5
4
3
2
1
0
31
2
1
0
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 95 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4.8 DDR Dual I/O Read (BDh, BEh)
The instruction
BDh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
BDh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
BEh is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
Then the memory contents, at the address given, is shifted out, in a DDR fashion, two bits at a time on each clock edge through IO0
(SI) and IO1 (SO). Two bits are shifted out at the SCK frequency by the rising and falling edge of the SCK signal.
The DDR Dual I/O Read command improves throughput with two I/O signals — IO0 (SI) and IO1 (SO). It is similar to the Dual I/O
Read command but transfers two address, mode, or data bits on every edge of the clock. In some applications, the reduced
instruction overhead might allow for code execution (XIP) directly from S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices.
The maximum operating clock frequency for DDR Dual I/O Read command is 80 MHz.
For DDR Dual I/O Read commands, there is a latency required after the last address bits are shifted into IO0 and IO1, before data
begins shifting out of IO0 and IO1. There are different ordering part numbers that select the latency code table used for this
command, either the High Performance LC (HPLC) table or the Enhanced High Performance LC (EHPLC) table. The number of
latency (dummy) clocks is determined by the frequency of SCK (refer to Table 27 on page 51 or Table 29 on page 51). The number
of dummy cycles is set by the LC bits in the Configuration Register (CR1).
The HPLC table does not provide cycles for mode bits so each Dual I/O command starts with the 8 bit instruction, followed by
address, followed by a latency period. This latency period allows the device’s internal circuitry enough time to access the initial
address. During these latency cycles, the data value on SI (IO0) and SO (IO1) are “don’t care” and may be high impedance. When
the Data Learning Pattern (DLP) is enabled the host system must not drive the IO signals during the dummy cycles. The IO signals
must be left high impedance by the host so that the memory device can drive the DLP during the dummy cycles.
The EHPLC table does provide cycles for mode bits so a series of Dual I/O DDR commands may eliminate the 8 bit instruction after
the first command sends a complementary mode bit pattern, as shown in Figure 9.27 and Figure 9.29 on page 97. This added
feature removes the need for the eight bit SDR instruction sequence and dramatically reduces initial access times (improves XIP
performance). The Mode bits control the length of the next DDR Dual I/O Read operation through the inclusion or exclusion of the
first byte instruction code. If the upper nibble (IO[7:4]) and lower nibble (IO[3:0]) of the Mode bits are complementary (i.e. 5h and Ah)
the device transitions to Continuous DDR Dual I/O Read Mode and the next address can be entered (after CS# is raised high and
then asserted low) without requiring the BDh or BEh instruction, as shown in Figure 9.28 on page 97, and thus, eliminating eight
cycles from the command sequence. The following sequences will release the device from Continuous DDR Dual I/O Read mode;
after which, the device can accept standard SPI commands:
1. During the DDR Dual I/O Read Command Sequence, if the Mode bits are not complementary the next time CS# is raised
high and then asserted low the device will be released from DDR Dual I/O Read mode.
2. During any operation, if CS# toggles high to low to high for eight cycles (or less) and data input (IO0 and IO1) are not set
for a valid instruction sequence, then the device will be released from DDR Dual I/O Read mode.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
CS# should not be driven high during mode or dummy bits as this may make the mode bits indeterminate. The HOLD function is not
valid during Dual I/O DDR commands.
Note that the memory devices may drive the IOs with a preamble prior to the first data value. The preamble is a data learning pattern
(DLP) that is used by the host controller to optimize data capture at higher frequencies. The preamble DLP drives the IO bus for the
four clock cycles immediately before data is output. The host must be sure to stop driving the IO bus prior to the time that the
memory starts outputting the preamble.
The preamble is intended to give the host controller an indication about the round trip time from when the host drives a clock edge to
when the corresponding data value returns from the memory device. The host controller will skew the data capture point during the
preamble period to optimize timing margins and then use the same skew time to capture the data during the rest of the read
operation. The optimized capture point will be determined during the preamble period of every read operation. This optimization
strategy is intended to compensate for both the PVT (process, voltage, temperature) of both the memory device and the host
controller as well as any system level delays caused by flight time on the PCB.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 96 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Although the data learning pattern (DLP) is programmable, the following example shows example of the DLP of 34h. The DLP 34h
(or 00110100) will be driven on each of the active outputs (i.e. all four SIOs on a x4 device, both SIOs on a x2 device and the single
SO output on a x1 device). This pattern was chosen to cover both DC and AC data transition scenarios. The two DC transition
scenarios include data low for a long period of time (two half clocks) followed by a high going transition (001) and the complementary
low going transition (110). The two AC transition scenarios include data low for a short period of time (one half clock) followed by a
high going transition (101) and the complementary low going transition (010). The DC transitions will typically occur with a starting
point closer to the supply rail than the AC transitions that may not have fully settled to their steady state (DC) levels. In many cases
the DC transitions will bound the beginning of the data valid period and the AC transitions will bound the ending of the data valid
period. These transitions will allow the host controller to identify the beginning and ending of the valid data eye. Once the data eye
has been characterized the optimal data capture point can be chosen. See Section 7.5.12 SPI DDR Data Learning Registers
on page 56 for more details.
Figure 9.27 DDR Dual I/O Read Initial Access (4-byte Address, BEh or BDh [ExtAdd=1], EHPLC= 01b)
CS#
0
1
6
2
5
3
4
5
2
6
1
7
0
8
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
SCK
8 cycles
Instruction
8 cycles
32b Add
2 cycles
Mode
5 cycles Dummy
Optional DLP
2 cycles
per data
IO0
IO1
7
4
3
30
31
2
2
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
7
7
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
0
0
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
Figure 9.28 Continuous DDR Dual I/O Read Subsequent Access (4-byte Address, EHPLC= 01b)
CS#
SCK
0
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
8
15
16
17
8 cycles
32b Add
2 cycles
Mode
5 cycles Dummy
Optional DLP
2 cycles
per data
IO0
IO1
30
31
2
2
2
3
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
7
7
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
0
0
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
6
7
Figure 9.29 DDR Dual I/O Read (4-byte Address, BEh or BDh [ExtAdd=1], HPLC=00b)
CS#
SCK
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
8 cycles
Instruction
8 cycles
32b Add
6 cycles
Dummy
2 cycles
per data
IO0
IO1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
30
31
2
0
1
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
6
7
3
1
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 97 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.4.9 DDR Quad I/O Read (EDh, EEh)
The Read DDR Quad I/O command improves throughput with four I/O signals - IO0-IO3. It is similar to the Quad I/O Read command
but allows input of the address four bits on every edge of the clock. In some applications, the reduced instruction overhead might
allow for code execution (XIP) directly from S25FL128S and S25FL256S devices. The QUAD bit of the Configuration Register must
be set (CR Bit1=1) to enable the Quad capability.
The instruction
EDh (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
EDh (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
EEh is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
The address is followed by mode bits. Then the memory contents, at the address given, is shifted out, in a DDR fashion, with four
bits at a time on each clock edge through IO0-IO3.
The maximum operating clock frequency for Read DDR Quad I/O command is 80 MHz.
For Read DDR Quad I/O, there is a latency required after the last address and mode bits are shifted into the IO0-IO3 signals before
data begins shifting out of IO0-IO3. This latency period (dummy cycles) allows the device’s internal circuitry enough time to access
the initial address. During these latency cycles, the data value on IO0-IO3 are “don’t care” and may be high impedance. When the
Data Learning Pattern (DLP) is enabled the host system must not drive the IO signals during the dummy cycles. The IO signals must
be left high impedance by the host so that the memory device can drive the DLP during the dummy cycles.
There are different ordering part numbers that select the latency code table used for this command, either the High Performance LC
(HPLC) table or the Enhanced High Performance LC (EHPLC) table. The number of dummy cycles is determined by the frequency
of SCK (refer to Table 27 on page 51). The number of dummy cycles is set by the LC bits in the Configuration Register (CR1).
Both latency tables provide cycles for mode bits so a series of Quad I/O DDR commands may eliminate the 8 bit instruction after the
first command sends a complementary mode bit pattern, as shown in Figure 9.30 and Figure 9.32. This feature removes the need
for the eight bit SDR instruction sequence and dramatically reduces initial access times (improves XIP performance). The Mode bits
control the length of the next Read DDR Quad I/O operation through the inclusion or exclusion of the first byte instruction code. If the
upper nibble (IO[7:4]) and lower nibble (IO[3:0]) of the Mode bits are complementary (i.e. 5h and Ah) the device transitions to
Continuous Read DDR Quad I/O Mode and the next address can be entered (after CS# is raised high and then asserted low)
without requiring the EDh or EEh instruction, as shown in Figure 9.31 on page 99 and Figure 9.33 on page 100 thus, eliminating
eight cycles from the command sequence. The following sequences will release the device from Continuous Read DDR Quad I/O
mode; after which, the device can accept standard SPI commands:
1. During the Read DDR Quad I/O Command Sequence, if the Mode bits are not complementary the next time CS# is raised
high and then asserted low the device will be released from Read DDR Quad I/O mode.
2. During any operation, if CS# toggles high to low to high for eight cycles (or less) and data input (IO0, IO1, IO2, and IO3)
are not set for a valid instruction sequence, then the device will be released from Read DDR Quad I/O mode.
The address can start at any byte location of the memory array. The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address
in sequential order after each byte of data is shifted out. The entire memory can therefore be read out with one single read
instruction and address 000000h provided. When the highest address is reached, the address counter will wrap around and roll back
to 000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
CS# should not be driven high during mode or dummy bits as this may make the mode bits indeterminate. The HOLD function is not
valid during Quad I/O DDR commands.
Note that the memory devices drive the IOs with a preamble prior to the first data value. The preamble is a pattern that is used by the
host controller to optimize data capture at higher frequencies. The preamble drives the IO bus for the four clock cycles immediately
before data is output. The host must be sure to stop driving the IO bus prior to the time that the memory starts outputting the
preamble.
The preamble is intended to give the host controller an indication about the round trip time from when the host drives a clock edge to
when the corresponding data value returns from the memory device. The host controller will skew the data capture point during the
preamble period to optimize timing margins and then use the same skew time to capture the data during the rest of the read
operation. The optimized capture point will be determined during the preamble period of every read operation. This optimization
strategy is intended to compensate for both the PVT (process, voltage, temperature) of both the memory device and the host
controller as well as any system level delays caused by flight time on the PCB.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 98 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Although the data learning pattern (DLP) is programmable, the following example shows example of the DLP of 34h. The DLP 34h
(or 00110100) will be driven on each of the active outputs (i.e. all four SIOs on a x4 device, both SIOs on a x2 device and the single
SO output on a x1 device). This pattern was chosen to cover both DC and AC data transition scenarios. The two DC transition
scenarios include data low for a long period of time (two half clocks) followed by a high going transition (001) and the complementary
low going transition (110). The two AC transition scenarios include data low for a short period of time (one half clock) followed by a
high going transition (101) and the complementary low going transition (010). The DC transitions will typically occur with a starting
point closer to the supply rail than the AC transitions that may not have fully settled to their steady state (DC) levels. In many cases
the DC transitions will bound the beginning of the data valid period and the AC transitions will bound the ending of the data valid
period. These transitions will allow the host controller to identify the beginning and ending of the valid data eye. Once the data eye
has been characterized the optimal data capture point can be chosen. See Section 7.5.12 SPI DDR Data Learning Registers
on page 56 for more details.
Figure 9.30 DDR Quad I/O Read Initial Access (3-byte Address, EDh [ExtAdd=0], HPLC=11b)
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
SCK
8 cycles
Instruction
3 cycles
Address
1 cycle
Mode
3 cycle Dummy
1 cycle per data
Data 0 Data 1
High-Z Bus Turn-around
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
20 16 12
8
9
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
4
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
21
22
23
17 13
1
2
3
5
6
7
18 14 10
19 15 11
Figure 9.31 Continuous DDR Quad I/O Read Subsequent Access (3-byte Address,HPLC=11b)
CS#
SCK
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
3 cycle
1 cycle
Mode
3 cycle Dummy
1 cycle per data
Address
High-Z Bus Turn-around
Data 0
Data 1
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
20
21
22
23
16
17
18
19
12
8
9
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
13
14
15
10
11
Figure 9.32 DDR Quad I/O Read Initial Access (4-byte Address, EEh or EDh [ExtAdd=1], EHPLC=01b)
CS#
SCK
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
8 cycles
Instruction
4 cycles
32 Bit Address
1 cycle
Mode
7 cycle Dummy
1 cycle per data
Data 0 Data 1
High-Z Bus Turn-around
Optional Data Learning Pattern
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
28 24 20 16 12
29 25 21 17 13
8
9
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
7
7
7
7
6
6
6
6
5
5
5
5
4
4
4
4
3
3
3
3
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
30 26 22 18 14 10
31 27 23 19 15 11
Note:
1. Example DLP of 34h (or 00110100).
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 99 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 9.33 Continuous DDR Quad I/O Read Subsequent Access (4-byte Address, EHPLC=01b)
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
SCK
4 cycles
32 Bit Address
1 cycle
Mode
7 cycle Dummy
1 cycle per data
Data 0 Data 1
High-Z Bus Turn-around
Optional Data Learning Pattern
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
28 24 20 16 12
29 25 21 17 13
8
9
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
7
7
7
7
6
6
6
6
5
5
5
5
4
4
4
4
3
3
3
3
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
30 26 22 18 14 10
31 27 23 19 15 11
Note:
1. Example DLP of 34h (or 00110100).
9.5
Program Flash Array Commands
9.5.1 Program Granularity
9.5.1.1 Automatic ECC
Each 16 byte aligned and 16 byte length Programming Block has an automatic Error Correction Code (ECC) value. The data block
plus ECC form an ECC unit. In combination with Error Detection and Correction (EDC) logic the ECC is used to detect and correct
any single bit error found during a read access. When data is first programmed within an ECC unit the ECC value is set for the entire
ECC unit. If the same ECC unit is programmed more than once the ECC value is changed to disable the Error Detection and
Correction (EDC) function. A sector erase is needed to again enable Automatic ECC on that Programming Block. The 16 byte
Program Block is the smallest program granularity on which Automatic ECC is enabled.
These are automatic operations transparent to the user. The transparency of the Automatic ECC feature enhances data accuracy
for typical programming operations which write data once to each ECC unit but, facilitates software compatibility to previous
generations of FL-S family of products by allowing for single byte programming and bit walking in which the same ECC unit is
programmed more than once. When an ECC unit has Automatic ECC disabled, EDC is not done on data read from the ECC unit
location.
An ECC status register is provided for determining if ECC is enabled on an ECC unit and whether any errors have been detected
and corrected in the ECC unit data or the ECC (See Section 7.5.6 ECC Status Register (ECCSR) on page 54.) The ECC Status
Register Read (ECCRD) command is used to read the ECC status on any ECC unit.
EDC is applied to all parts of the Flash address spaces other than registers. An ECC is calculated for each group of bytes protected
and the ECC is stored in a hidden area related to the group of bytes. The group of protected bytes and the related ECC are together
called an ECC unit.
ECC is calculated for each 16 byte aligned and length ECC unit.
Single Bit EDC is supported with 8 ECC bits per ECC unit, plus 1 bit for an ECC disable Flag.
Sector erase resets all ECC bits and ECC disable flags in a sector to the default state (enabled).
ECC is programmed as part of the standard Program commands operation.
ECC is disabled automatically if multiple programming operations are done on the same ECC unit.
Single byte programming or bit walking is allowed but disables ECC on the second program to the same 16-byte ECC unit.
The ECC disable flag is programmed when ECC is disabled.
To re-enable ECC for an ECC unit that has been disabled, the Sector that includes the ECC unit must be erased.
To ensure the best data integrity provided by EDC, each ECC unit should be programmed only once so that ECC is stored for that
unit and not disabled.
The calculation, programming, and disabling of ECC is done automatically as part of a programming operation. The detection and
correction, if needed, is done automatically as part of read operations. The host system sees only corrected data from a read
operation.
ECC protects the OTP region - however a second program operation on the same ECC unit will disable ECC permanently on that
ECC unit (OTP is one time programmable, hence an erase operation to re-enable the ECC enable/indicator bit is prohibited).
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 100 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.5.1.2 Page Programming
Page Programming is done by loading a Page Buffer with data to be programmed and issuing a programming command to move
data from the buffer to the memory array. This sets an upper limit on the amount of data that can be programmed with a single
programming command. Page Programming allows up to a page size (either 256 or 512 bytes) to be programmed in one operation.
The page size is determined by the Ordering Part Number (OPN). The page is aligned on the page size address boundary. It is
possible to program from one bit up to a page size in each Page programming operation. It is recommended that a multiple of 16
byte length and aligned Program Blocks be written. For the very best performance, programming should be done in full pages of 512
bytes aligned on 512-byte boundaries with each Page being programmed only once.
9.5.1.3 Single Byte Programming
Single Byte Programming allows full backward compatibility to the standard SPI Page Programming (PP) command by allowing a
single byte to be programmed anywhere in the memory array. While single byte programming is supported, this will disable
Automatic ECC on the 16 byte ECC unit where the byte is located
9.5.2 Page Program (PP 02h or 4PP 12h)
The Page Program (PP) commands allows bytes to be programmed in the memory (changing bits from 1 to 0). Before the Page
Program (PP) commands can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the
device. After the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded successfully, the device sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in
the Status Register to enable any write operations.
The instruction
02h (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
02h (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
12h is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
and at least one data byte on SI. Depending on the device OPN, the page size can either be 256 or 512 bytes. Up to a page can be
provided on SI after the 3-byte address with instruction 02h or 4-byte address with instruction 12h has been provided. If the 9 least
significant address bits (A8-A0) are not all zero, all transmitted data that goes beyond the end of the current page are programmed
from the start address of the same page (from the address whose 9 least significant bits (A8-A0) are all zero) i.e. the address wraps
within the page aligned address boundaries. This is a result of only requiring the user to enter one single page address to cover the
entire page boundary.
If less than a page of data is sent to the device, these data bytes will be programmed in sequence, starting at the provided address
within the page, without having any affect on the other bytes of the same page.
For optimized timings, using the Page Program (PP) command to load the entire page size program buffer within the page boundary
will save overall programming time versus loading less than a page size into the program buffer.
The programming process is managed by the flash memory device internal control logic. After a programming command is issued,
the programming operation status can be checked using the Read Status Register-1 command. The WIP bit (SR1[0]) will indicate
when the programming operation is completed. The P_ERR bit (SR1[6]) will indicate if an error occurs in the programming operation
that prevents successful completion of programming.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 101 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 64. Page Program (PP) Command Sequence (3-byte Address, 02h)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
SCK
SI
24-Bit
Instruction
Data Byte 1
Address
23 22 21
MSB
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
CS
#
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 59 51 52 53 54 55
SCK
Data Byte 2
Data Byte 3
Data Byte 512
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
MSB
Figure 65. Page Program (4PP) Command Sequence (4-byte Address, 12h)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
SI
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
Data Byte 1
31 30 29
MSB
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
CS
#
48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
SCK
SI
Data Byte 2
Data Byte 3
Data Byte 512
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 102 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.5.3 Quad Page Program (QPP 32h or 38h, or 4QPP 34h)
The Quad-input Page Program (QPP) command allows bytes to be programmed in the memory (changing bits from 1 to 0). The
Quad-input Page Program (QPP) command allows up to a page size (either 256 or 512 bytes) of data to be loaded into the Page
Buffer using four signals: IO0-IO3. QPP can improve performance for PROM Programmer and applications that have slower clock
speeds (< 12 MHz) by loading 4 bits of data per clock cycle. Systems with faster clock speeds do not realize as much benefit for the
QPP command since the inherent page program time becomes greater than the time it takes to clock-in the data. The maximum
frequency for the QPP command is 80 MHz.
To use Quad Page Program the Quad Enable Bit in the Configuration Register must be set (QUAD=1). A Write Enable command
must be executed before the device will accept the QPP command (Status
Register 1, WEL=1).
The instruction
32h (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
32h (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
38h (ExtAdd=0) is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) or
38h (ExtAdd=1) is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0) or
34h is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
and at least one data byte, into the IO signals. Data must be programmed at previously erased (FFh) memory locations.
The programming page is aligned on the page size address boundary. It is possible to program from one bit up to a page size in
each Page programming operation. It is recommended that a multiple of 16 byte length and aligned Program Blocks be written. This
insures that Automatic ECC is not disabled.
All other functions of QPP are identical to Page Program. The QPP command sequence is shown in Figure 66.
Figure 66. Quad 512-Byte Page Program Command Sequence (3-Byte Address, 32h or 38h)
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
SCK
24-Bit
Address
Instruction
IO0
23 22 21
3
2
1
0
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
56
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
*
IO1
IO2
7
7
7
7
IO3
*
*
*
*
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4
CS#
SCK
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Byte 5 Byte 6 Byte 7 Byte 8 Byte 9 Byte 10 Byte 11 Byte 12
Byte 509 Byte 510Byte 511Byte 512
*MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 103 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 67. Quad 256-Byte Page Program Command Sequence (3-Byte Address, 32h or 38h)
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
SCK
24-Bit
Address
Instruction
IO0
23 22 21
3
2
1
0
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
56
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
*
IO1
IO2
7
7
7
7
IO3
*
*
*
*
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4
CS#
SCK
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Byte 5 Byte 6 Byte 7 Byte 8 Byte 9 Byte 10 Byte 11 Byte 12
Byte 253 Byte 254Byte 255Byte 256
*MSB
Figure 68. Quad 512-Byte Page Program Command Sequence (4-Byte Address, 34h or 32h or 38h [ExtAdd=1])
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
IO0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
56
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
*
*
IO1
IO2
7
7
7
7
IO3
*
*
*
*
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4
CS#
SCK
48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
*
*
510
*
511
*
512
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Byte 5 Byte 6 Byte 7 Byte 8 Byte 9 Byte 10 Byte 11 Byte 12
Byte
509
Byte
Byte
Byte
*MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 104 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 69. Quad 256-Byte Page Program Command Sequence (4-Byte Address, 34h or 32h or 38h [ExtAdd=1])
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
IO0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
56
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
*
*
IO1
IO2
7
7
7
7
IO3
*
*
*
*
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4
CS#
SCK
48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
IO0
IO1
IO2
IO3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
*
*
254
*
255
*
256
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Byte 5 Byte 6 Byte 7 Byte 8 Byte 9 Byte 10 Byte 11 Byte 12
Byte
253
Byte
Byte
Byte
*MSB
9.5.4 Program Suspend (PGSP 85h) and Resume (PGRS 8Ah)
The Program Suspend command allows the system to interrupt a programming operation and then read from any other non-erase-
suspended sector or non-program-suspended-page. Program Suspend is valid only during a programming operation.
Commands allowed after the Program Suspend command is issued:
Read Status Register 1 (RDSR1 05h)
Read Status Register 2 (RDSR2 07h)
The Write in Progress (WIP) bit in Status Register 1 (SR1[0]) must be checked to know when the programming operation has
stopped. The Program Suspend Status bit in the Status Register-2 (SR2[0]) can be used to determine if a programming operation
has been suspended or was completed at the time WIP changes to 0. The time required for the suspend operation to complete is
tPSL, see Table 51 on page 120.
See Table 49 on page 110 for the commands allowed while programming is suspend.
The Program Resume command 8Ah must be written to resume the programming operation after a Program Suspend. If the
programming operation was completed during the suspend operation, a resume command is not needed and has no effect if issued.
Program Resume commands will be ignored unless a Program operation is suspended.
After a Program Resume command is issued, the WIP bit in the Status Register-1 will be set to a 1 and the programming operation
will resume. Program operations may be interrupted as often as necessary e.g. a program suspend command could immediately
follow a program resume command but, in order for a program operation to progress to completion there must be some periods of
time between resume and the next suspend command greater than or equal to tPRS. See Table 51 on page 120.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 105 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 9.34 Program Suspend Command Sequence
tPSL
CS#
SCK
Prog. Suspend
Mode Command
Program Suspend Instruction
Read Status
0
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
7
6
SO
7
0
Figure 70. Program Resume Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction (8Ah)
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
Resume Programming
9.6
Erase Flash Array Commands
9.6.1 Parameter 4-kB Sector Erase (P4E 20h or 4P4E 21h)
The P4E command is implemented only in FL128S and FL256S. The P4E command is ignored when the device is configured with
the 256-kB sector option.
The Parameter 4-kB Sector Erase (P4E) command sets all the bits of a 4-kbyte parameter sector to 1 (all bytes are FFh). Before the
P4E command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the device, which
sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to enable any write operations.
The instruction
20h [ExtAdd=0] is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0), or
20h [ExtAdd=1] is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0), or
21h is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
CS# must be driven into the logic high state after the twenty-fourth or thirty-second bit of the address has been latched in on SI. This
will initiate the beginning of internal erase cycle, which involves the pre-programming and erase of the chosen sector of the flash
memory array. If CS# is not driven high after the last bit of address, the sector erase operation will not be executed.
As soon as CS# is driven high, the internal erase cycle will be initiated. With the internal erase cycle in progress, the user can read
the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit to determine when the operation has been completed. The WIP bit will indicate a 1.
when the erase cycle is in progress and a 0 when the erase cycle has been completed.
A P4E command applied to a sector that has been write protected through the Block Protection bits or ASP, will not be executed and
will set the E_ERR status. A P4E command applied to a sector that is larger than
4 kbytes will not be executed and will not set the E_ERR status.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 106 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 71. Parameter Sector Erase Command Sequence (3-Byte Address, 20h)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31
SCK
SI
Instruction
24 Bit Address
23 22 21
MSB
3
2
1
0
Figure 72. Parameter Sector Erase Command Sequence (ExtAdd = 1, 20h or 4-Byte Address, 21h)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39
SCK
SI
Instruction
32 Bit Address
31 30 29
MSB
3
2
1
0
9.6.2 Sector Erase (SE D8h or 4SE DCh)
The Sector Erase (SE) command sets all bits in the addressed sector to 1 (all bytes are FFh). Before the Sector Erase (SE)
command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the device, which sets
the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to enable any write operations.
The instruction
D8h [ExtAdd=0] is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0), or
D8h [ExtAdd=1] is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0), or
DCh is followed by a 4-byte address (A31-A0)
CS# must be driven into the logic high state after the twenty-fourth or thirty-second bit of address has been latched in on SI. This will
initiate the erase cycle, which involves the pre-programming and erase of the chosen sector. If CS# is not driven high after the last
bit of address, the sector erase operation will not be executed.
As soon as CS# is driven into the logic high state, the internal erase cycle will be initiated. With the internal erase cycle in progress,
the user can read the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit to check if the operation has been completed. The WIP bit will indicate
a 1 when the erase cycle is in progress and a0 when the erase cycle has been completed.
A Sector Erase (SE) command applied to a sector that has been Write Protected through the Block Protection bits or ASP, will not
be executed and will set the E_ERR status.
A device ordering option determines whether the SE command erases 64 kbytes or 256 kbytes. The option to use this command to
always erase 256 kbytes provides for software compatibility with higher density and future S25FL family devices.
ASP has a PPB and a DYB protection bit for each sector, including any 4-kB sectors. If a sector erase command is applied to a 64-
kB range that includes a protected 4-kB sector, or to a 256-kB range that includes a 64-kB protected address range, the erase will
not be executed on the range and will set the E_ERR status.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 107 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 73. Sector Erase Command Sequence (ExtAdd = 0, 3-Byte Address, D8h)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31
SCK
SI
Instruction
24 Bit Address
23 22 21
MSB
3
2
1
0
Figure 74. Sector Erase Command Sequence (ExtAdd = 1, D8h or 4-Byte Address, DCh)
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39
SCK
Instruction
32 Bit Address
SI
31 30 29
M SB
3
2
1
0
9.6.3 Bulk Erase (BE 60h or C7h)
The Bulk Erase (BE) command sets all bits to 1 (all bytes are FFh) inside the entire flash memory array. Before the BE command
can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the device, which sets the Write
Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to enable any write operations.
CS# must be driven into the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction byte has been latched in on SI. This will initiate the
erase cycle, which involves the pre-programming and erase of the entire flash memory array. If CS# is not driven high after the last
bit of instruction, the BE operation will not be executed.
As soon as CS# is driven into the logic high state, the erase cycle will be initiated. With the erase cycle in progress, the user can
read the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit to determine when the operation has been completed. The WIP bit will indicate a 1
when the erase cycle is in progress and a 0 when the erase cycle has been completed.
A BE command can be executed only when the Block Protection (BP2, BP1, BP0) bits are set to 0’s. If the BP bits are not zero, the
BE command is not executed and E_ERR is not set. The BE command will skip any sectors protected by the DYB or PPB and the
E_ERR status will not be set.
Figure 75. Bulk Erase Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction
SI
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 108 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.6.4 Erase Suspend and Resume Commands (ERSP 75h or ERRS 7Ah)
The Erase Suspend command, allows the system to interrupt a sector erase operation and then read from or program data to, any
other sector. Erase Suspend is valid only during a sector erase operation. The Erase Suspend command is ignored if written during
the Bulk Erase operation.
When the Erase Suspend command is written during the sector erase operation, the device requires a maximum of tESL (erase
suspend latency) to suspend the erase operation and update the status bits. See Table 52 on page 120.
Commands allowed after the Erase Suspend command is issued:
Read Status Register 1 (RDSR1 05h)
Read Status Register 2 (RDSR2 07h)
The Write in Progress (WIP) bit in Status Register 1 (SR1[0]) must be checked to know when the erase operation has stopped. The
Erase Suspend bit in Status Register-2 (SR2[1]) can be used to determine if an erase operation has been suspended or was
completed at the time WIP changes to 0.
If the erase operation was completed during the suspend operation, a resume command is not needed and has no effect if issued.
Erase Resume commands will be ignored unless an Erase operation is suspended.
See Table 49 on page 110 for the commands allowed while erase is suspend.
After the erase operation has been suspended, the sector enters the erase-suspend mode. The system can read data from or
program data to the device. Reading at any address within an erase-suspended sector produces undetermined data.
A WREN command is required before any command that will change non-volatile data, even during erase suspend.
The WRR and PPB Erase commands are not allowed during Erase Suspend, it is therefore not possible to alter the Block Protection
or PPB bits during Erase Suspend. If there are sectors that may need programming during Erase suspend, these sectors should be
protected only by DYB bits that can be turned off during Erase Suspend. However, WRR is allowed immediately following the BRAC
command; in this special case the WRR is interpreted as a write to the Bank Address Register, not a write to SR1 or CR1.
If a program command is sent for a location within an erase suspended sector the program operation will fail with the P_ERR bit set.
After an erase-suspended program operation is complete, the device returns to the erase-suspend mode. The system can
determine the status of the program operation by reading the WIP bit in the Status Register, just as in the standard program
operation.
The Erase Resume command 7Ah must be written to resume the erase operation if an Erase is suspend. Erase Resume commands
will be ignored unless an Erase is Suspend.
After an Erase Resume command is sent, the WIP bit in the status register will be set to a 1 and the erase operation will continue.
Further Resume commands are ignored.
Erase operations may be interrupted as often as necessary e.g. an erase suspend command could immediately follow an erase
resume command but, in order for an erase operation to progress to completion there must be some periods of time between
resume and the next suspend command greater than or equal to tERS. See Table 52 on page 120.
Figure 9.35 Erase Suspend Command Sequence
tESL
CS#
SCK
Erase Suspend
Erase Suspend Instruction
Read Status
0
Mode Command
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
7
6
SO
7
0
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 109 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 76. Erase Resume Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction (7Ah)
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
Resume Sector or Block Erase
Table 49. Commands Allowed During Program or Erase Suspend
Instruction
Name
Instruction Allowed During
Code (Hex) Erase Suspend Program Suspend
Allowed During
Comment
Bank address register may need to be changed during a suspend to
reach a sector for read or program.
BRAC
BRRD
B9
16
17
30
E0
E1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Bank address register may need to be changed during a suspend to
reach a sector for read or program.
Bank address register may need to be changed during a suspend to
reach a sector for read or program.
BRWR
CLSR
Clear status may be used if a program operation fails during erase
suspend.
It may be necessary to remove and restore dynamic protection during
erase suspend to allow programming during erase suspend.
DYBRD
DYBWR
It may be necessary to remove and restore dynamic protection during
erase suspend to allow programming during erase suspend.
ERRS
DDRFR
7A
0D
0E
0B
0C
FF
X
X
X
X
X
X
Required to resume from erase suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
X
X
X
X
X
4DDRFR
FAST_READ
4FAST_READ
MBR
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
May need to reset a read operation during suspend.
Needed to resume a program operation. A program resume may also be
used during nested program suspend within an erase suspend.
PGRS
8A
X
X
PGSP
PP
85
02
12
X
X
X
Program suspend allowed during erase suspend.
Required for array program during erase suspend.
Required for array program during erase suspend.
4PP
Allowed for checking persistent protection before attempting a program
command during erase suspend.
PPBRD
E2
X
QPP
4QPP
4READ
RDCR
DIOR
32, 38
34
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Required for array program during erase suspend.
Required for array program during erase suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
13
X
X
X
X
X
X
35
BB
BC
3B
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
4DIOR
DOR
4DOR
3C
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 110 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 49. Commands Allowed During Program or Erase Suspend (Continued)
Instruction
Name
Instruction Allowed During
Code (Hex) Erase Suspend Program Suspend
Allowed During
Comment
DDRDIOR
4DDRDIOR
DDRQIOR
DDRQIOR4
QIOR
BD
BE
ED
EE
EB
EC
6B
6C
05
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
All array reads allowed in suspend.
Needed to read WIP to determine end of suspend process.
4QIOR
QOR
4QOR
RDSR1
Needed to read suspend status to determine whether the operation is
suspended or complete.
RDSR2
07
X
X
READ
RESET
WREN
03
F0
06
X
X
X
X
X
All array reads allowed in suspend.
Reset allowed anytime.
Required for program command within erase suspend.
Bank register may need to be changed during a suspend to reach a
sector needed for read or program. WRR is allowed when following
BRAC.
WRR
01
X
X
9.7
One Time Program Array Commands
9.7.1 OTP Program (OTPP 42h)
The OTP Program command programs data in the One Time Program region, which is in a different address space from the main
array data. The OTP region is 1024 bytes so, the address bits from A23 to A10 must be zero for this command. Refer to Section 7.4
OTP Address Space on page 46 for details on the OTP region. The protocol of the OTP Program command is the same as the Page
Program command. Before the OTP Program command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be
issued and decoded by the device, which sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to enable any write operations.
To program the OTP array in bit granularity, the rest of the bits within a data byte can be set to 1.
Each region in the OTP memory space can be programmed one or more times, provided that the region is not locked. Attempting to
program zeros in a region that is locked will fail with the P_ERR bit in SR1 set to 1 Programming ones, even in a protected area does
not cause an error and does not set P_ERR. Subsequent OTP programming can be performed only on the un-programmed bits (that
is, 1 data).
Figure 77. OTP Program Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
SCK
SI
24-Bit
Instruction
Data Byte 1
Address
23 22 21
0
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
MSB
MSB
CS#
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 59 51 52 53 54 55
SCK
SI
Data Byte 2
Data Byte 3
Data Byte 512
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 111 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.7.2 OTP Read (OTPR 4Bh)
The OTP Read command reads data from the OTP region. The OTP region is 1024 bytes so, the address bits from A23 to A10 must
be zero for this command. Refer to Section 7.4 OTP Address Space on page 46 for details on the OTP region. The protocol of the
OTP Read command is similar to the Fast Read command except that it will not wrap to the starting address after the OTP address
is at its maximum; instead, the data beyond the maximum OTP address will be undefined. Also, the OTP Read command is not
affected by the latency code. The OTP read command always has one dummy byte of latency as shown below.
Figure 9.36 OTP Read Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
24-Bit
Address
Instruction
Dummy Byte
SI
23 22 21
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 1
DATA OUT 2
High Impedance
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
MSB
9.8
Advanced Sector Protection Commands
9.8.1 ASP Read (ASPRD 2Bh)
The ASP Read instruction 2Bh is shifted into SI by the rising edge of the SCK signal. Then the 16-bit ASP register contents is shifted
out on the serial output SO, least significant byte first. Each bit is shifted out at the SCK frequency by the falling edge of the SCK
signal. It is possible to read the ASP register continuously by providing multiples of 16 clock cycles. The maximum operating clock
frequency for the ASP Read (ASPRD) command is 133 MHz.
Figure 9.37 ASPRD Command
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
Register Out
Register Out
High Impedance
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
15 14 13 12 11 10
9
8
SO
MSB
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 112 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.8.2 ASP Program (ASPP 2Fh)
Before the ASP Program (ASPP) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued. After
the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded, the device will set the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to
enable any write operations.
The ASPP command is entered by driving CS# to the logic low state, followed by the instruction and two data bytes on SI, least
significant byte first. The ASP Register is two data bytes in length.
The ASPP command affects the P_ERR and WIP bits of the Status and Configuration Registers in the same manner as any other
programming operation.
CS# input must be driven to the logic high state after the sixteenth bit of data has been latched in. If not, the ASPP command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed ASPP operation is initiated. While the ASPP operation is in
progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In Progress (WIP) bit is a
1 during the self-timed ASPP operation, and is a 0 when it is completed. When the ASPP operation is completed, the Write Enable
Latch (WEL) is set to a 0.
Figure 9.38 ASPP Command
CS#
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15
SCK
Instruction
Register In
15 14 13 12 11 10
9
8
SI
7
6
3
2
1
0
4
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
5
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.8.3 DYB Read (DYBRD E0h)
The instruction E0h is latched into SI by the rising edge of the SCK signal. Followed by the 32-bit address selecting location zero
within the desired sector (note, the high order address bits not used by a particular density device must be zero). Then the 8-bit DYB
access register contents are shifted out on the serial output SO. Each bit is shifted out at the SCK frequency by the falling edge of
the SCK signal. It is possible to read the same DYB access register continuously by providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The
address of the DYB register does not increment so this is not a means to read the entire DYB array. Each location must be read with
a separate DYB Read command. The maximum operating clock frequency for READ command is 133 MHz.
Figure 78. DYBRD Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 1
High Impedance
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 113 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.8.4 DYB Write (DYBWR E1h)
Before the DYB Write (DYBWR) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued. After
the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded, the device will set the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to
enable any write operations.
The DYBWR command is entered by driving CS# to the logic low state, followed by the instruction, the 32-bit address selecting
location zero within the desired sector (note, the high order address bits not used by a particular density device must be zero), then
the data byte on SI. The DYB Access Register is one data byte in length.
The DYBWR command affects the P_ERR and WIP bits of the Status and Configuration Registers in the same manner as any other
programming operation. CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the eighth bit of data has been latched in. If not, the DYBWR
command is not executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed DYBWR operation is initiated. While the
DYBWR operation is in progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-
In Progress (WIP) bit is a 1 during the self-timed DYBWR operation, and is a 0 when it is completed. When the DYBWR operation is
completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) is set to a 0.
Figure 79. DYBWR Command Sequence
CS#
0
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
SI
32-Bit
Instruction
Data Byte 1
Address
31 30 29
MSB
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
9.8.5 PPB Read (PPBRD E2h)
The instruction E2h is shifted into SI by the rising edges of the SCK signal, followed by the 32-bit address selecting location zero
within the desired sector (note, the high order address bits not used by a particular density device must be zero) Then the 8-bit PPB
access register contents are shifted out on SO.
It is possible to read the same PPB access register continuously by providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The address of the PPB
register does not increment so this is not a means to read the entire PPB array. Each location must be read with a separate PPB
Read command. The maximum operating clock frequency for the PPB Read command is 133 MHz.
Figure 80. PPBRD Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
SCK
32-Bit
Address
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 1
High Impedance
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 114 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.8.6 PPB Program (PPBP E3h)
Before the PPB Program (PPBP) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued. After
the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded, the device will set the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status Register to
enable any write operations.
The PPBP command is entered by driving CS# to the logic low state, followed by the instruction, followed by the 32-bit address
selecting location zero within the desired sector (note, the high order address bits not used by a particular density device must be
zero).
The PPBP command affects the P_ERR and WIP bits of the Status and Configuration Registers in the same manner as any other
programming operation.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the last bit of address has been latched in. If not, the PPBP command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed PPBP operation is initiated. While the PPBP operation is in
progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In Progress (WIP) bit is a
1 during the self-timed PPBP operation, and is a 0 when it is completed. When the PPBP operation is completed, the Write Enable
Latch (WEL) is set to a 0.
Figure 81. PPBP Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
36 37
38
39
35
SCK
Instruction
32 bit Address
3
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
31 30 29
MSB
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.8.7 PPB Erase (PPBE E4h)
The PPB Erase (PPBE) command sets all PPB bits to 1. Before the PPB Erase command can be accepted by the device, a Write
Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the device, which sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) in the Status
Register to enable any write operations.
The instruction E4h is shifted into SI by the rising edges of the SCK signal.
CS# must be driven into the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction byte has been latched in on SI. This will initiate the
beginning of internal erase cycle, which involves the pre-programming and erase of the entire PPB memory array. Without CS#
being driven to the logic high state after the eighth bit of the instruction, the PPB erase operation will not be executed.
With the internal erase cycle in progress, the user can read the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit to check if the operation has
been completed. The WIP bit will indicate a 1 when the erase cycle is in progress and a 0 when the erase cycle has been completed.
Erase suspend is not allowed during PPB Erase.
Figure 82. PPB Erase Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 115 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.8.8 PPB Lock Bit Read (PLBRD A7h)
The PPB Lock Bit Read (PLBRD) command allows the PPB Lock Register contents to be read out of SO. It is possible to read the
PPB lock register continuously by providing multiples of eight clock cycles. The PPB Lock Register contents may only be read when
the device is in standby state with no other operation in progress. It is recommended to check the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit of the
Status Register before issuing a new command to the device.
Figure 9.39 PPB Lock Register Read Command Sequence
CS#
SCK
SI
SO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Phase
Instruction
Register Read
Repeat Register Read
9.8.9 PPB Lock Bit Write (PLBWR A6h)
The PPB Lock Bit Write (PLBWR) command clears the PPB Lock Register to zero. Before the PLBWR command can be accepted
by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be issued and decoded by the device, which sets the Write Enable Latch
(WEL) in the Status Register to enable any write operations.
The PLBWR command is entered by driving CS# to the logic low state, followed by the instruction.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the eighth bit of instruction has been latched in. If not, the PLBWR command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed PLBWR operation is initiated. While the PLBWR operation
is in progress, the Status Register may still be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In Progress
(WIP) bit is a 1 during the self-timed PLBWR operation, and is a 0 when it is completed. When the PLBWR operation is completed,
the Write Enable Latch (WEL) is set to a 0. The maximum clock frequency for the PLBWR command is 133 MHz.
Figure 83. PPB Lock Bit Write Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.8.10 Password Read (PASSRD E7h)
The correct password value may be read only after it is programmed and before the Password Mode has been selected by
programming the Password Protection Mode bit to 0 in the ASP Register (ASP[2]). After the Password Protection Mode is selected
the PASSRD command is ignored.
The PASSRD command is shifted into SI. Then the 64-bit Password is shifted out on the serial output SO, least significant byte first,
most significant bit of each byte first. Each bit is shifted out at the SCK frequency by the falling edge of the SCK signal. It is possible
to read the Password continuously by providing multiples of 64 clock cycles. The maximum operating clock frequency for the
PASSRD command is 133 MHz.
Figure 84. Password Read Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11
69 70 71 72
SCK
Instruction
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
Password Least Sig. Byte First
58 57 56
High Impedance
7
7
6
5
4
SO
MSB
MSB
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 116 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.8.11 Password Program (PASSP E8h)
Before the Password Program (PASSP) command can be accepted by the device, a Write Enable (WREN) command must be
issued and decoded by the device. After the Write Enable (WREN) command has been decoded, the device sets the Write Enable
Latch (WEL) to enable the PASSP operation.
The password can only be programmed before the Password Mode is selected by programming the Password Protection Mode bit
to 0 in the ASP Register (ASP[2]). After the Password Protection Mode is selected the PASSP command is ignored.
The PASSP command is entered by driving CS# to the logic low state, followed by the instruction and the password data bytes on
SI, least significant byte first, most significant bit of each byte first. The password is sixty-four (64) bits in length.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the sixty-fourth (64th) bit of data has been latched. If not, the PASSP command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed PASSP operation is initiated. While the PASSP operation
is in progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In Progress (WIP) bit
is a 1 during the self-timed PASSP cycle, and is a 0 when it is completed. The PASSP command can report a program error in the
P_ERR bit of the status register. When the PASSP operation is completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) is set to a 0. The
maximum clock frequency for the PASSP command is 133 MHz.
Figure 9.40 Password Program Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
68 69
70
71
SCK
Instruction
Password
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
59
58
57
56
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.8.12 Password Unlock (PASSU E9h)
The PASSU command is entered by driving CS# to the logic low state, followed by the instruction and the password data bytes on
SI, least significant byte first, most significant bit of each byte first. The password is sixty-four (64) bits in length.
CS# must be driven to the logic high state after the sixty-fourth (64th) bit of data has been latched. If not, the PASSU command is not
executed. As soon as CS# is driven to the logic high state, the self-timed PASSU operation is initiated. While the PASSU operation
is in progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write-In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write-In Progress (WIP) bit
is a 1 during the self-timed PASSU cycle, and is a 0 when it is completed.
If the PASSU command supplied password does not match the hidden password in the Password Register, an error is reported by
setting the P_ERR bit to 1. The WIP bit of the status register also remains set to 1. It is necessary to use the CLSR command to
clear the status register, the RESET command to software reset the device, or drive the RESET# input low to initiate a hardware
reset, in order to return the P_ERR and WIP bits to 0. This returns the device to standby state, ready for new commands such as a
retry of the PASSU command.
If the password does match, the PPB Lock bit is set to 1. The maximum clock frequency for the PASSU command is 133 MHz.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 117 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Figure 9.41 Password Unlock Command Sequence
CS#
SCK
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
68 69
70
71
Instruction
Password
SI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
59
58
57
56
MSB
MSB
High Impedance
SO
9.9
Reset Commands
9.9.1 Software Reset Command (RESET F0h)
The Software Reset command (RESET) restores the device to its initial power up state, except for the volatile FREEZE bit in the
Configuration register CR1[1] and the volatile PPB Lock bit in the PPB Lock Register. The Freeze bit and the PPB Lock bit will
remain set at their last value prior to the software reset. To clear the FREEZE bit and set the PPB Lock bit to its protection mode
selected power on state, a full power-on-reset sequence or hardware reset must be done. Note that the non-volatile bits in the
configuration register, TBPROT, TBPARM, and BPNV, retain their previous state after a Software Reset. The Block Protection bits
BP2, BP1, and BP0, in the status register will only be reset if they are configured as volatile via the BPNV bit in the Configuration
Register (CR1[3]) and FREEZE is cleared to zero . The software reset cannot be used to circumvent the FREEZE or PPB Lock bit
protection mechanisms for the other security configuration bits. The reset command is executed when CS# is brought to high state
and requires tRPH time to execute.
Figure 85. Software Reset Command Sequence
CS#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
SI
Instruction
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 118 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
9.9.2 Mode Bit Reset (MBR FFh)
The Mode Bit Reset (MBR) command can be used to return the device from continuous high performance read mode back to normal
standby awaiting any new command. Because some device packages lack a hardware RESET# input and a device that is in a
continuous high performance read mode may not recognize any normal SPI command, a system hardware reset or software reset
command may not be recognized by the device. It is recommended to use the MBR command after a system reset when the
RESET# signal is not available or, before sending a software reset, to ensure the device is released from continuous high
performance read mode.
The MBR command sends Ones on SI or IO0 for 8 SCK cycles. IO1 to IO3 are “don’t care” during these cycles.
Figure 86. Mode Bit Reset Command Sequence
CS
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SCK
Instruction (FFh)
SI
High Impedance
SO
9.10 Embedded Algorithm Performance Tables
Table 50. Program and Erase Performance
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ (1)
Max (2)
Unit
tW
WRR Write Time
140
500
ms
Page Programming (512 bytes)
Page Programming (256 bytes)
340
250
750
750 (3)
tPP
µs
ms
ms
Sector Erase Time (64-kB / 4-kB physical sectors)
130
650 (4)
Sector Erase Time
(64 kB Top/Bottom: logical sector = 16 x 4-kB physical sectors)
2,080
10,400
tSE
Sector Erase Time
(256-kB logical sectors = 4 x 64-kB physical sectors)
520
2600
ms
Bulk Erase Time (S25FL128S)
Bulk Erase Time (S25FL256S)
33
66
165
330
sec
sec
tBE
tBE
Notes:
1. Typical program and erase times assume the following conditions: 25°C, V = 3.0V; 10,000 cycles; checkerboard data pattern.
CC
2. Under worst case conditions of 90°C; 100,000 cycles max.
3. Maximum value also applies to OTPP, PPBP, ASPP, PASSP, ABWR, and PNVDLR programming commands.
4. Maximum value also applies to the PPBE erase command.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 119 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 51. Program Suspend AC Parameters
Parameter
Min
Typical
Max
Unit
Comments
The time from Program Suspend command
until the WIP bit is 0
Program Suspend Latency (tPSL
)
40
µs
Minimum is the time needed to issue the next
Program Suspend command but ≥ typical
periods are needed for Program to progress to
completion
Program Resume to next Program
Suspend (tPRS
0.06
100
µs
)
Table 52. Erase Suspend AC Parameters
Parameter
Min
Typical
Max
Unit
Comments
The time from Erase Suspend command until
the WIP bit is 0
Erase Suspend Latency (tESL
)
45
µs
Minimum is the time needed to issue the next
Erase Suspend command but ≥ typical periods
are needed for the Erase to progress to
completion
Erase Resume to next Erase Suspend
(tERS)
0.06
100
µs
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 120 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
10. Data Integrity
10.1 Erase Endurance
Table 10.1 Erase Endurance
Parameter
Minimum
Unit
Program/Erase cycles per main Flash array sectors
100K
100K
PE cycle
PE cycle
Program/Erase cycles per PPB array or non-volatile register array (1)
Note:
1. Each write command to a non-volatile register causes a PE cycle on the entire non-volatile register array.
10.2 Data Retention
Table 10.2 Data Retention
Minimum
Time
Parameter
Test Conditions
Unit
10K Program/Erase Cycles
100K Program/Erase Cycles
20
2
Years
Years
Data Retention Time
Contact Cypress Sales and FAE for further information on the data integrity. An application note is available at:
www.cypress.com/appnotes
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 121 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
11. Software Interface Reference
11.1 Command Summary
Table 53. S25FL128S and S25FL256S Instruction Set (sorted by instruction)
Instruction (Hex)
Command Name
WRR
Command Description
Write Register (Status-1, Configuration-1)
Page Program (3- or 4-byte address)
Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Write Disable
Maximum Frequency (MHz)
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
0B
0C
0D
0E
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
133
133
50
PP
READ
WRDI
133
133
133
133
133
133
80
RDSR1
WREN
Read Status Register-1
Write Enable
RDSR2
FAST_READ
4FAST_READ
DDRFR
4DDRFR
4PP
Read Status Register-2
Fast Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Fast Read (4-byte address)
DDR Fast Read (3- or 4-byte address)
DDR Fast Read (4-byte address)
Page Program (4-byte address)
Read (4-byte address)
80
133
50
4READ
ABRD
AutoBoot Register Read
AutoBoot Register Write
Bank Register Read
133
133
133
133
133
ABWR
BRRD
BRWR
Bank Register Write
ECCRD
ECC Read
Parameter 4 kB-sector Erase (3- or 4-byte
address)
20
P4E
133
21
2B
2F
4P4E
ASPRD
ASPP
Parameter 4 kB-sector Erase (4-byte address)
133
133
133
ASP Read
ASP Program
Clear Status Register - Erase/Program Fail
Reset
30
CLSR
133
32
34
35
38
3B
3C
41
42
43
4A
4B
QPP
4QPP
Quad Page Program (3- or 4-byte address)
Quad Page Program (4-byte address)
Read Configuration Register-1
Quad Page Program (3- or 4-byte address)
Read Dual Out (3- or 4-byte address)
Read Dual Out (4-byte address)
Data Learning Pattern Read
80
80
RDCR
QPP
133
80
DOR
104
104
133
133
133
133
133
4DOR
DLPRD
OTPP
PNVDLR
WVDLR
OTPR
OTP Program
Program NV Data Learning Register
Write Volatile Data Learning Register
OTP Read
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 122 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 53. S25FL128S and S25FL256S Instruction Set (sorted by instruction) (Continued)
Instruction (Hex)
Command Name
BE
Command Description
Maximum Frequency (MHz)
60
6B
6C
75
7A
85
8A
90
Bulk Erase
133
104
104
133
133
133
133
133
QOR
Read Quad Out (3- or 4-byte address)
Read Quad Out (4-byte address)
Erase Suspend
4QOR
ERSP
ERRS
Erase Resume
PGSP
Program Suspend
PGRS
Program Resume
READ_ID (REMS)
Read Electronic Manufacturer Signature
Read ID (JEDEC Manufacturer ID and JEDEC
CFI)
9F
RDID
133
A3
A6
A7
AB
MPM
PLBWR
PLBRD
RES
Reserved for Multi-I/O-High Perf Mode (MPM)
PPB Lock Bit Write
133
133
133
50
PPB Lock Bit Read
Read Electronic Signature
Bank Register Access
B9
BRAC
133
(Legacy Command formerly used for Deep
Power Down)
BB
BC
BD
BE
C7
D8
DC
E0
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
EB
EC
ED
EE
F0
DIOR
4DIOR
Dual I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Dual I/O Read (4-byte address)
DDR Dual I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
DDR Dual I/O Read (4-byte address)
Bulk Erase (alternate command)
Erase 64 kB or 256 kB (3- or 4-byte address)
Erase 64 kB or 256 kB (4-byte address)
DYB Read
104
104
80
DDRDIOR
4DDRDIOR
BE
80
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
133
SE
4SE
DYBRD
DYBWR
PPBRD
PPBP
DYB Write
PPB Read
PPB Program
PPBE
PPB Erase
Reserved-E5
Reserved-E6
PASSRD
PASSP
PASSU
QIOR
Reserved
Reserved
Password Read
133
133
133
104
104
80
Password Program
Password Unlock
Quad I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
Quad I/O Read (4-byte address)
DDR Quad I/O Read (3- or 4-byte address)
DDR Quad I/O Read (4-byte address)
Software Reset
4QIOR
DDRQIOR
4DDRQIOR
RESET
MBR
80
133
133
FF
Mode Bit Reset
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 123 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
11.2 Device ID and Common Flash Interface (ID-CFI) Address Map
11.2.1 Field Definitions
Table 54. Manufacturer and Device ID
Byte Address
Data
Description
Manufacturer ID for Cypress
00h
01h
20h (128 Mb)
02h (256 Mb)
01h
02h
Device ID Most Significant Byte - Memory Interface Type
Device ID Least Significant Byte - Density
18h (128 Mb)
19h (256 Mb)
ID-CFI Length - number bytes following. Adding this value to the
current location of 03h gives the address of the last valid location
in the ID-CFI address map. A value of 00h indicates the entire
512-byte ID-CFI space must be read because the actual length of
the ID-CFI information is longer than can be indicated by this
legacy single byte field. The value is OPN dependent.
03h
04h
4Dh
00h (Uniform 256-kB sectors)
01h (4-kB parameter sectors with uniform Sector Architecture
64-kB sectors)
05h
06h
80h (FL-S Family)
xxh
Family ID
ASCII characters for Model
Refer to Section 12. Ordering Information on page 141 for the
model number definitions.
07h
xxh
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
xxh
xxh
xxh
xxh
xxh
xxh
xxh
xxh
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Table 55. CFI Query Identification String
Byte Address
Data
Description
10h
11h
12h
51h
52h
59h
Query Unique ASCII string “QRY”
13h
14h
02h
00h
Primary OEM Command Set
FL-P backward compatible command set ID
15h
16h
40h
00h
Address for Primary Extended Table
17h
18h
53h
46h
Alternate OEM Command Set
ASCII characters “FS” for SPI (F) interface, S Technology
19h
1Ah
51h
00h
Address for Alternate OEM Extended Table
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 124 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 56. CFI System Interface String
Byte Address
Data
27h
36h
00h
00h
06h
Description
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
VCC Min. (erase/program): 100 millivolts
VCC Max. (erase/program): 100 millivolts
VPP Min. voltage (00h = no VPP present)
VPP Max. voltage (00h = no VPP present)
Typical timeout per single byte program 2N µs
08h (256B page)
09h (512B page)
Typical timeout for Min. size Page program 2N µs
(00h = not supported)
20h
21h
22h
08h (4 kB or 64 kB)
09h (256 kB)
Typical timeout per individual sector erase 2N ms
0Fh (128 Mb)
10h (256 Mb)
Typical timeout for full chip erase 2N ms (00h = not supported)
23h
24h
25h
02h
02h
03h
Max. timeout for byte program 2N times typical
Max. timeout for page program 2N times typical
Max. timeout per individual sector erase 2N times typical
Max. timeout for full chip erase 2N times typical
(00h = not supported)
26h
03h
Table 57. Device Geometry Definition for 128-Mbit and 256-Mbit Bottom Boot Initial Delivery State
Byte Address
Data
Description
18h (128 Mb)
19h (256 Mb)
27h
28h
Device Size = 2N bytes
02h
Flash Device Interface Description:
0000h = x8 only
0001h = x16 only
0002h = x8/x16 capable
0003h = x32 only
29h
01h
0004h = Single I/O SPI, 3-byte address
0005h = Multi I/O SPI, 3-byte address
0102h = Multi I/O SPI, 3- or 4-byte address
2Ah
2Bh
08h
00h
Max. number of bytes in multi-byte write = 2N
(0000 = not supported
0008h = 256B page
0009h = 512B page)
Number of Erase Block Regions within device
1 = Uniform Device, 2 = Boot Device
2Ch
02h
2Dh
2Eh
2Fh
30h
31h
1Fh
00h
10h
00h
FDh
Erase Block Region 1 Information (refer to JEDEC JEP137):
32 sectors = 32-1 = 001Fh
4-kB sectors = 256 bytes x 0010h
Erase Block Region 2 Information:
254 sectors = 254-1 = 00FDh (128 Mb)
510 sectors = 510-1 = 01FDh (256 Mb)
64-kB sectors = 0100h x 256 bytes
00h (128 Mb)
01h (256 Mb)
32h
33h
34h
00h
01h
FFh
35h thru 3Fh
RFU
Note:
1. FL-S 128 Mbit and 256-Mbit devices have either a hybrid sector architecture with thirty two 4-kB sectors and all remaining sectors of 64-kB or with uniform 256-kB
sectors. Devices with the hybrid sector architecture are initially shipped from Cypress with the 4 kB sectors located at the bottom of the array address map. However,
the device configuration TBPARM bit CR1[2] may be programed to invert the sector map to place the 4-kB sectors at the top of the array address map. The CFI
geometry information of the above table is relevant only to the initial delivery state of a hybrid sector device. The flash device driver software must examine the
TBPARM bit to determine if the sector map was inverted at a later time.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 125 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 58. Device Geometry Definition for 128-Mbit and 256-Mbit Uniform Sector Devices
Byte Address
Data
Description
18h (128 Mb)
19h (256 Mb)
27h
28h
Device Size = 2N bytes
02h
01h
Flash Device Interface Description:
0000h = x8 only
0001h = x16 only
0002h = x8/x16 capable
0003h = x32 only
0004h = Single I/O SPI, 3-byte address
0005h = Multi I/O SPI, 3-byte address
0102h = Multi I/O SPI, 3- or 4-byte address
29h
2Ah
2Bh
09h
00h
Max. number of bytes in multi-byte write = 2N
(0000 = not supported
0008h = 256B page
0009h = 512B page)
Number of Erase Block Regions within device
1 = Uniform Device, 2 = Boot Device
2Ch
2Dh
01h
3Fh (128 Mb)
7Fh (256 Mb)
Erase Block Region 1 Information (refer to JEDEC JEP137):
64 sectors = 64-1 = 003Fh (128 Mb)
128 sectors = 128-1 = 007Fh (256 Mb)
2Eh
2Fh
00h
00h
04h
FFh
256-kB sectors = 256 bytes x 0400h
30h
31h thru 3Fh
RFU
Table 59. CFI Primary Vendor-Specific Extended Query
Byte Address
Data
50h
52h
49h
31h
33h
Description
40h
41h
42h
43h
44h
Query-unique ASCII string “PRI”
Major version number = 1, ASCII
Minor version number = 3, ASCII
Address Sensitive Unlock (Bits 1-0)
00b = Required
01b = Not Required
Process Technology (Bits 5-2)
0000b = 0.23 µm Floating Gate
0001b = 0.17 µm Floating Gate
0010b = 0.23 µm MirrorBit
45h
46h
21h
02h
0011b = 0.11 µm Floating Gate
0100b = 0.11 µm MirrorBit
0101b = 0.09 µm MirrorBit
1000b = 0.065 µm MirrorBit
Erase Suspend
0 = Not Supported
1 = Read Only
2 = Read and Program
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 126 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 59. CFI Primary Vendor-Specific Extended Query (Continued)
Byte Address
Data
Description
Sector Protect
00 = Not Supported
47h
01h
X = Number of sectors in group
Temporary Sector Unprotect
00 = Not Supported
01 = Supported
48h
49h
00h
08h
Sector Protect/Unprotect Scheme
04 = High Voltage Method
05 = Software Command Locking Method
08 = Advanced Sector Protection Method
09 = Secure
Simultaneous Operation
00 = Not Supported
4Ah
4Bh
00h
01h
X = Number of Sectors
Burst Mode (Synchronous sequential read) support
00 = Not Supported
01 = Supported
Page Mode Type, model dependent
00 = Not Supported
01 = 4 Word Read Page
02 = 8 Read Word Page
4Ch
xxh
03 = 256-Byte Program Page
04 = 512-Byte Program Page
ACC (Acceleration) Supply Minimum
00 = Not Supported, 100 mV
4Dh
4Eh
00h
00h
ACC (Acceleration) Supply Maximum
00 = Not Supported, 100 mV
WP# Protection
01 = Whole Chip
4Fh
50h
07h
01h
04 = Uniform Device with Bottom WP Protect
05 = Uniform Device with Top WP Protect
07 = Uniform Device with Top or Bottom Write Protect (user select)
Program Suspend
00 = Not Supported
01 = Supported
The Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query provides information related to the expanded command set provided by the FL-S
family. The alternate query parameters use a format in which each parameter begins with an identifier byte and a parameter length
byte. Driver software can check each parameter ID and can use the length value to skip to the next parameter if the parameter is not
needed or not recognized by the software.
Table 60. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Header
Byte Address
Data
41h
4Ch
54h
32h
30h
Description
51h
52h
53h
54h
55h
Query-unique ASCII string “ALT”
Major version number = 2, ASCII
Minor version number = 0, ASCII
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 127 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 61. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 0
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Data
Description
Offset
00h
01h
00h
10h
Parameter ID (Ordering Part Number)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value
to the current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
53h
32h
35h
46h
4Ch
ASCII “S” for manufacturer (Cypress)
ASCII “25” for Product Characters (Single Die SPI)
ASCII “FL” for Interface Characters (SPI 3 Volt)
31h (128 Mb)
32h (256 Mb)
07h
08h
09h
32h (128 Mb)
35h (256 Mb)
ASCII characters for density
38h (128 Mb)
36h (256 Mb)
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
53h
ASCII “S” for Technology (65 nm MirrorBit)
xxh
Reserved for Future Use (RFU)
Table 62. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 80h Address Options
Parameter Relative
Byte Address Off-
set
Data
Description
00h
80h
01h
Parameter ID (address options)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value
to the current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
01h
Bits 7:4 - Reserved = 1111b
Bit 3 - AutoBoot support - Ye s= 0b, No = 1b
02h
F0h
Bit 2 - 4-byte address instructions supported - Yes = 0b, No = 1b
Bit 1 - Bank address + 3-byte address instructions supported - Yes = 0b, No = 1b
Bit 0 - 3-byte address instructions supported - Yes = 0b, No = 1b
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 128 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 63. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 84h Suspend Commands
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Offset
Data
Description
00h
01h
84h
08h
Parameter ID (Suspend Commands
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value
to the current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
85h
2Dh
8Ah
64h
75h
2Dh
7Ah
64h
Program suspend instruction code
Program suspend latency maximum (µs)
Program resume instruction code
Program resume to next suspend typical (µs)
Erase suspend instruction code
Erase suspend latency maximum (µs)
Erase resume instruction code
Erase resume to next suspend typical (µs)
Table 64. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 88h Data Protection
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Data
Description
Offset
00h
01h
88h
04h
Parameter ID (Data Protection)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value
to the current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
02h
03h
0Ah
01h
OTP size 2N bytes, FFh = not supported
OTP address map format, 01h = FL-S format, FFh = not supported
Block Protect Type, model dependent
00h = FL-P, FL-S, FFh = not supported
04h
05h
xxh
xxh
Advanced Sector Protection type, model dependent
01h = FL-S ASP
Table 65. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 8Ch Reset Timing
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Data
8Ch
06h
Description
Offset
00h
01h
Parameter ID (Reset Timing)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter.
Adding this value to the current location value +1 = the first byte of the
next parameter)
02h
03h
96h
01h
POR maximum value
POR maximum exponent 2N µs
FFh (without separate RESET#)
23h (with separate RESET #)
04h
Hardware Reset maximum value
05h
06h
07h
00h
23h
00h
Hardware Reset maximum exponent 2N µs
Software Reset maximum value, FFh = not supported
Software Reset maximum exponent 2N µs
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 129 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 66. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 90h - HPLC(SDR)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Offset
Data
Description
00h
01h
90h
56h
Parameter ID (Latency Code Table)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value to the
current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
20h
21h
22h
23h
24h
25h
26h
27h
06h
0Eh
46h
43h
03h
13h
0Bh
0Ch
3Bh
3Ch
6Bh
6Ch
BBh
BCh
EBh
ECh
32h
03h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
04h
02h
01h
50h
00h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
00h
08h
Number of rows
Row length in bytes
Start of header (row 1), ASCII “F” for frequency column header
ASCII “C” for Code column header
Read 3-byte address instruction
Read 4-byte address instruction
Read Fast 3-byte address instruction
Read Fast 4-byte address instruction
Read Dual Out 3-byte address instruction
Read Dual Out 4-byte address instruction
Read Quad Out 3-byte address instruction
Read Quad Out 4-byte address instruction
Dual I/O Read 3-byte address instruction
Dual I/O Read 4-byte address instruction
Quad I/O Read 3-byte address instruction
Quad I/O Read 4-byte address instruction
Start of row 2, SCK frequency limit for this row (50 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (11b)
Read mode cycles
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 3, SCK frequency limit for this row (80 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (00b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 130 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 66. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 90h - HPLC(SDR) (Continued)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Offset
Data
Description
28h
29h
2Ah
2Bh
2Ch
2Dh
2Eh
2Fh
30h
31h
32h
33h
34h
35h
36h
37h
38h
39h
3Ah
3Bh
3Ch
3Dh
3Eh
3Fh
40h
41h
42h
43h
44h
45h
46h
47h
48h
49h
4Ah
4Bh
4Ch
4Dh
4Eh
4Fh
50h
00h
08h
00h
04h
02h
04h
5Ah
01h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
05h
02h
04h
68h
02h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
06h
02h
05h
85h
02h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
FFh
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 4, SCK frequency limit for this row (90 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (01b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 5, SCK frequency limit for this row (104 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (10b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 6, SCK frequency limit for this row (133 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (10b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 131 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 66. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 90h - HPLC(SDR) (Continued)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Offset
Data
Description
51h
52h
53h
54h
55h
56h
57h
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Table 67. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 9Ah - HPLC DDR
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Offset
Data
Description
00h
01h
9Ah
2Ah
Parameter ID (Latency Code Table)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value to the
current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
05h
08h
46h
43h
0Dh
0Eh
BDh
BEh
EDh
EEh
32h
03h
00h
04h
00h
04h
01h
03h
42h
00h
00h
05h
00h
06h
01h
06h
42h
Number of rows
Row length in bytes
Start of header (row 1), ASCII “F” for frequency column header
ASCII “C” for Code column header
Read Fast DDR 3-byte address instruction
Read Fast DDR 4-byte address instruction
DDR Dual I/O Read 3-byte address instruction
DDR Dual I/O Read 4-byte address instruction
Read DDR Quad I/O 3-byte address instruction
Read DDR Quad I/O 4-byte address instruction
Start of row 2, SCK frequency limit for this row (50 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (11b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Start of row 3, SCK frequency limit for this row (66 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (00b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Start of row 4, SCK frequency limit for this row (66 MHz)
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 132 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 67. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 9Ah - HPLC DDR (Continued)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address
Offset
Data
Description
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
20h
21h
22h
23h
24h
25h
26h
27h
28h
29h
2Ah
2Bh
01h
00h
06h
00h
07h
01h
07h
42h
02h
00h
07h
00h
08h
01h
08h
Latency Code for this row (01b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Start of row 5, SCK frequency limit for this row (66 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (10b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Table 68. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 90h - EHPLC (SDR)
Parameter Relative
Data
Description
Byte Address Offset
00h
90h
Parameter ID (Latency Code Table)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value to the
current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
01h
56h
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
06h
0Eh
46h
43h
03h
13h
0Bh
0Ch
3Bh
3Ch
6Bh
6Ch
BBh
BCh
EBh
ECh
32h
03h
00h
00h
Number of rows
Row length in bytes
Start of header (row 1), ASCII “F” for frequency column header
ASCII “C” for Code column header
Read 3-byte address instruction
Read 4-byte address instruction
Read Fast 3-byte address instruction
Read Fast 4-byte address instruction
Read Dual Out 3-byte address instruction
Read Dual Out 4-byte address instruction
Read Quad Out 3-byte address instruction
Read Quad Out 4-byte address instruction
Dual I/O Read 3-byte address instruction
Dual I/O Read 4-byte address instruction
Quad I/O Read 3-byte address instruction
Quad I/O Read 4-byte address instruction
Start of row 2, SCK frequency limit for this row (50 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (11b)
Read mode cycles
Read latency cycles
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 133 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 68. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 90h - EHPLC (SDR) (Continued)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address Offset
Data
Description
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
20h
21h
22h
23h
24h
25h
26h
27h
28h
29h
2Ah
2Bh
2Ch
2Dh
2Eh
2Fh
30h
31h
32h
33h
34h
35h
36h
37h
38h
39h
3Ah
3Bh
3Ch
3Dh
3Eh
3Fh
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
04h
00h
02h
01h
50h
00h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
08h
04h
00h
02h
04h
5Ah
01h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
08h
04h
01h
02h
04h
68h
02h
FFh
FFh
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 3, SCK frequency limit for this row (80 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (00b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 4, SCK frequency limit for this row (90 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (01b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 5, SCK frequency limit for this row (104 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (10b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 134 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 68. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 90h - EHPLC (SDR) (Continued)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address Offset
Data
Description
40h
41h
42h
43h
44h
45h
46h
47h
48h
49h
4Ah
4Bh
4Ch
4Dh
4Eh
4Fh
50h
51h
52h
53h
54h
55h
56h
57h
00h
08h
00h
08h
00h
08h
04h
02h
02h
05h
85h
02h
FFh
FFh
00h
08h
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Start of row 6, SCK frequency limit for this row (133 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (10b)
Read mode cycles (FFh = command not supported at this frequency)
Read latency cycles
Read Fast mode cycles
Read Fast latency cycles
Read Dual Out mode cycles
Read Dual Out latency cycles
Read Quad Out mode cycles
Read Quad Out latency cycles
Dual I/O Read mode cycles
Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Quad I/O Read mode cycles
Quad I/O Read latency cycles
Table 69. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 9Ah - EHPLC DDR
Parameter Relative
Data
9Ah
2Ah
Description
Byte Address Offset
00h
Parameter ID (Latency Code Table)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value to the
current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
01h
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
05h
08h
46h
43h
0Dh
0Eh
BDh
BEh
EDh
EEh
32h
Number of rows
Row length in bytes
Start of header (row 1), ASCII “F” for frequency column header
ASCII “C” for Code column header
Read Fast DDR 3-byte address instruction
Read Fast DDR 4-byte address instruction
DDR Dual I/O Read 3-byte address instruction
DDR Dual I/O Read 4-byte address instruction
Read DDR Quad I/O 3-byte address instruction
Read DDR Quad I/O 4-byte address instruction
Start of row 2, SCK frequency limit for this row (50 MHz)
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 135 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 69. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 9Ah - EHPLC DDR (Continued)
Parameter Relative
Byte Address Offset
Data
Description
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
20h
21h
22h
23h
24h
25h
26h
27h
28h
29h
2Ah
2Bh
03h
04h
01h
02h
02h
01h
03h
42h
00h
04h
02h
02h
04h
01h
06h
42h
01h
04h
04h
02h
05h
01h
07h
42h
02h
04h
05h
02h
06h
01h
08h
Latency Code for this row (11b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Start of row 3, SCK frequency limit for this row (66 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (00b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Start of row 4, SCK frequency limit for this row (66 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (01b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Start of row 5, SCK frequency limit for this row (66 MHz)
Latency Code for this row (10b)
Read Fast DDR mode cycles
Read Fast DDR latency cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read mode cycles
DDR Dual I/O Read latency cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O mode cycles
Read DDR Quad I/O latency cycles
Table 70. CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter F0h RFU
Parameter Relative
Data
Description
Byte Address Offset
00h
01h
F0h
0Fh
Parameter ID (RFU)
Parameter Length (The number of following bytes in this parameter. Adding this value to the
current location value +1 = the first byte of the next parameter)
02h
...
FFh
FFh
FFh
RFU
RFU
RFU
10h
This parameter type (Parameter ID F0h) may appear multiple times and have a different length each time. The parameter is used to
reserve space in the ID-CFI map or to force space (pad) to align a following parameter to a required boundary.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 136 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
11.3 Device ID and Common Flash Interface (ID-CFI) ASO Map — Automotive Only
The CFI Primary Vendor-Specific Extended Query is extended to include Electronic Marking information for device traceability.
# of
bytes
Example of
ActualData
Data
Format
Address
Data Field
Hex Read Out of Example Data
(SA) + 0180h
Size of Electronic Marking
1
1
8
1
1
1
7
Hex
Hex
20
1
14h
01h
(SA) + 0181h Revision of Electronic Marking
(SA) + 0182h
(SA) + 018Ah
(SA) + 018Bh
(SA) + 018Ch
(SA) + 018Dh
Fab Lot #
Wafer #
ASCII
Hex
LD87270 4Ch, 44h, 38h, 37h, 32h, 37h, 30h, FFh
23
10
15
17h
0Ah
0Fh
Die X Coordinate
Die Y Coordinate
Class Lot #
Hex
Hex
ASCII
BR33150 42h, 52h, 33h, 33h, 31h, 35h, 30h
FFh, FFh, FFh, FFh, FFh, FFh, FFh, FFh,
FFh, FFh, FFh, FFh
(SA) + 0194h
Reserved for Future
12
N/A
N/A
Fab Lot # + Wafer # + Die X Coordinate + Die Y Coordinate gives a unique ID for each device.
11.4 Registers
The register maps are copied in this section as a quick reference. See Section 7.5 Registers on page 48 for the full description of the
register contents.
Table 71. Status Register 1 (SR1)
Field
Bits
Function
Type
Default State
Description
Name
1 = Locks state of SRWD, BP, and configuration
register bits when WP# is low by ignoring WRR
command
Status Register
Write Disable
7
SRWD
Non-Volatile
0
0
0 = No protection, even when WP# is low
1 = Error occurred
0 = No Error
Programming
Error Occurred
6
5
P_ERR
E_ERR
Volatile, Read only
Volatile, Read only
1= Error occurred
0 = No Error
Erase Error
Occurred
0
4
3
BP2
BP1
1 if CR1[3]=1,
Volatile if CR1[3]=1,
Non-Volatile if
CR1[3]=0
Protects selected range of sectors (Block) from
Program or Erase
0 when
shipped from
Cypress
Block Protection
2
BP0
1 = Device accepts Write Registers (WRR), program
or erase commands
Write Enable
Latch
0 = Device ignores Write Registers (WRR), program
or erase commands
This bit is not affected by WRR, only WREN and
WRDI commands affect this bit.
1
WEL
Volatile
0
0
1= Device Busy, a Write Registers (WRR), program,
erase or other operation is in progress
0 = Ready Device is in standby mode and can
accept commands
0
WIP
Write in Progress Volatile, Read only
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 137 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 72. Configuration Register (CR1)
Default
State
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
7
6
LC1
LC0
0
0
Selects number of initial read latency cycles
See Latency Code Tables
Latency Code
Non-Volatile
1 = BP starts at bottom (Low address)
0 = BP starts at top (High address)
Configures Start of Block
Protection
5
4
3
TBPROT
RFU
OTP
OTP
OTP
0
0
0
RFU
Reserved for Future Use
Configures BP2-0 in Sta-
tus Register
1 = Volatile
0 = Non-Volatile
BPNV
1 = 4-kB physical sectors at top, (high address)
0 = 4-kB physical sectors at bottom (Low
address)
Configures Parameter
Sectors location
2
1
TBPARM
QUAD
OTP
0
0
RFU in uniform sector devices.
Puts the device into Quad
I/O operation
1 = Quad
0 = Dual or Serial
Non-Volatile
Lock current state of BP2-
0 bits in Status Register,
TBPROT and TBPARM in
Configuration Register,
and OTP regions
1 = Block Protection and OTP locked
0 = Block Protection and OTP un-locked
0
FREEZE
Volatile
0
Table 73. Status Register 2 (SR2)
Bits
7
Field Name
RFU
Function
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Type
Default State
Description
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
Reserved for Future Use
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
RFU
5
RFU
4
RFU
3
RFU
2
RFU
1 = In erase suspend mode.
0 = Not in erase suspend mode.
1
0
ES
PS
EraseSuspend Volatile, Read only
0
0
1 = In program suspend mode.
0 = Not in program suspend mode.
Program Sus-
Volatile, Read only
pend
Table 74. Bank Address Register (BAR)
Bits Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
1 = 4-byte (32 bits) addressing required from command.
0 = 3-byte (24 bits) addressing from command + Bank
Address
Extended Address
Enable
7
EXTADD
Volatile
0b
6 to 2
RFU
BA25
BA24
Reserved
Volatile
Volatile
Volatile
00000b
Reserved for Future Use
1
0
Bank Address
Bank Address
0
0
RFU for lower density devices
A24 for 256-Mbit device, RFU for lower density device
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 138 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 75. ASP Register (ASPR)
Default
State
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
15 to 9
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
RFU
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
OTP
1
Reserved for Future Use
8
7
6
5
4
3
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
1
Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
(Note 1) Reserved for Future Use
Password Protection
Mode Lock Bit
0 = Password Protection Mode Permanently Enabled.
1 = Password Protection Mode not Permanently Enabled.
2
PWDMLB
OTP
1
Persistent Protection
Mode Lock Bit
0 = Persistent Protection Mode Permanently Enabled.
1 = Persistent Protection Mode not Permanently Enabled.
1
0
PSTMLB
RFU
OTP
OTP
1
1
Reserved
Reserved for Future Use
Note:
1. Default value depends on ordering part number, see Section 11.5 Initial Delivery State on page 140.
Table 76. Password Register (PASS)
Field
Bits
Function
Type
Default State
Description
Name
Non-volatile OTP storage of 64-bit password. The
password is no longer readable after the password
protection mode is selected by programming ASP
register bit 2 to zero.
FFFFFFFF-
FFFFFFFFh
63 to 0
PWD HiddenPassword
OTP
Table 77. PPB Lock Register (PPBL)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Volatile
Default State
00h
Description
Reserved for Future Use
0 = PPB array protected until next power
7 to 1
RFU
Reserved
Persistent Protection Mode = 1 cycle or hardware reset
Password Protection Mode = 0 1 = PPB array may be programmed or
erased
0
PPBLOCK Protect PPBArray Volatile
Table 78. PPB Access Register (PPBAR)
Default
State
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
Description
00h = PPB for the sector addressed by the PPBRD or
PPBP command is programmed to ‘0’, protecting that
sector from program or erase operations.
FFh = PPB for the sector addressed by the PPBRD or
PPBP command is erased to ‘1’, not protecting that
sector from program or erase operations.
Read or Program
per sector PPB
7 to 0
PPB
Non-volatile
FFh
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 139 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Table 79. DYB Access Register (DYBAR)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
00h = DYB for the sector addressed by the DYBRD or DYBP
command is cleared to ‘0’, protecting that sector from program or
erase operations.
FFh = DYB for the sector addressed by the DYBRD or DYBP
command is set to ‘1’, not protecting that sector from program or
erase operations.
Read or Write
per sector DYB
7 to 0
DYB
Volatile
FFh
Table 80. Non-Volatile Data Learning Register (NVDLR)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
OTP value that may be transferred to the host during DDR read
command latency (dummy) cycles to provide a training pattern to
help the host more accurately center the data capture point in
the received data bits.
Non-Volatile
Data Learning
Pattern
7 to 0
NVDLP
OTP
00h
Table 81. Volatile Data Learning Register (NVDLR)
Bits
Field Name
Function
Type
DefaultState
Description
Takes the
value of
NVDLR
Volatile Data
Learning Pat- Volatile
tern
Volatile copy of the NVDLP used to enable and deliver the Data
Learning Pattern (DLP) to the outputs. The VDLP may be
7 to 0
VDLP
during POR changed by the host during system operation.
or Reset
11.5 Initial Delivery State
The device is shipped from Cypress with non-volatile bits set as follows:
The entire memory array is erased: i.e. all bits are set to 1 (each byte contains FFh).
The OTP address space has the first 16 bytes programmed to a random number. All other bytes are erased to FFh.
The ID-CFI address space contains the values as defined in the description of the ID-CFI address space.
The Status Register 1 contains 00h (all SR1 bits are cleared to 0’s).
The Configuration Register 1 contains 00h.
The Autoboot register contains 00h.
The Password Register contains FFFFFFFF-FFFFFFFFh.
All PPB bits are 1.
The ASP Register contents depend on the ordering options selected:
Table 82. ASP Register Content
Ordering Part Number Model
ASPR Default Value
00, 20, 30, R0, A0, B0, C0, D0,
01, 21, 31, R1, A1, B1, C1, D1,
90, Q0, 70, 60, 80,
FE7Fh
91, Q1, 71, 61, 81
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 140 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
12. Ordering Information
The ordering part number is formed by a valid combination of the following:
S25FL
256
S
AG
M
F
I
0
0
1
Packing Type
0 = Tray
1 = Tube
3 = 13” Tape and Reel
Model Number (Sector Type)
0 = Uniform 64-kB sectors
1 = Uniform 256-kB sectors
Model Number (Latency Type, Package Details, RESET# and V_IO Support)
0 = EHPLC, SO/WSON footprint
2 = EHPLC, 5 x 5 ball BGA footprint
3 = EHPLC, 4 x 6 ball BGA footprint
G = EHPLC, SO footprint with RESET#
R = EHPLC, SO footprint with RESET# and V
IO
A = EHPLC, 5 x 5 ball BGA footprint with RESET# and V
IO
B = EHPLC, 4 x 6 ball BGA footprint with RESET# and V
C = EHPLC, 5 x 5 ball BGA footprint with RESET#
D = EHPLC, 4 x 6 ball BGA footprint with RESET#
9 = HPLC, SO/WSON footprint
IO
4 = HPLC, 5 x 5 ball BGA footprint
8 = HPLC, 4 x 6 ball BGA footprint
H = HPLC, SO footprint with RESET#
Q = HPLC, SO footprint with RESET# and V
IO
7 = HPLC, 5 x 5 ball BGA footprint with RESET# and V
6 = HPLC, 4 x 6 ball BGA footprint with RESET# and V
E = HPLC, 5 x 5 ball BGA footprint with RESET#
F = HPLC, 4 x 6 ball BGA footprint with RESET#
IO
IO
Temperature Range / Grade
I = Industrial (-40°C to + 85°C)
V = Industrial Plus (-40°C to + 105°C)
A = Automotive, AEC-Q100 Grade 3 (-40°C to +85°C)
B = Automotive, AEC-Q100 Grade 2 (-40°C to +105°C)
M = Automotive, AEC-Q100 Grade 1 (-40°C to +125°C)
Package Materials
F = Lead (Pb)-free
H = Low-Halogen, Lead (Pb)-free
Package Type
M = 16-pin SO package
N = 8-contact WSON 6 x 8 mm package
B = 24-ball BGA 6 x 8 mm package, 1.00 mm pitch
Speed
AG = 133 MHz
DP = 66 MHz DDR
DS = 80 MHz DDR
Device Technology
S = 65 nm MirrorBit Process Technology
Density
128 = 128 Mbit
256 = 256 Mbit
Device Family
S25FL
Cypress Memory 3.0 Volt-Only, Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Flash Memory
Notes:
1. EHPLC = Enhanced High Performance Latency Code table.
2. HPLC = High Performance Latency Code table.
3. Uniform 64-kB sectors = A hybrid of 32 x 4-kB sectors with all remaining sectors being 64 kB, with a 256B programming buffer.
4. Uniform 256-kB sectors = All sectors are uniform 256-kB with a 512B programming buffer.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 141 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Valid Combinations — Standard
Valid Combinations list configurations planned to be supported in volume for this device. Consult your local sales office to confirm
availability of specific valid combinations and to check on newly released combinations.
Table 83. S25FL128S/S25FL256S Valid Combinations — Standard
Valid Combinations — Standard
Package and
Temperature
Base Ordering
Part Number
Speed
Option
Model Number
00, 01, G0, G1, R0, R1
00, 01
Packing Type
0, 1, 3
Package Marking (1)
FL + (Density) + SA + (Temp) + F +
(Model Number)
MFI, MFV
NFI, NFV
BHI, BHV
FL + (Density) + SA + (Temp) + F +
(Model Number)
AG
DP
DS
0, 1, 3
20, 21, 30, 31, A0, A1, B0,
B1, C0, C1, D0, D1
FL + (Density) + SA + (Temp) + H +
(Model Number)
0, 3
MFI
G0, G1
00, 01
0, 1, 3
0, 1, 3
FL + (Density) + SD + (Temp) + F +
(Model Number)
MFV
S25FL128S
or
S25FL256S
FL + (Density) + SD + (Temp) + F +
(Model Number)
NFI, NFV
BHI, BHV
MFI, MFV
NFI, NFV
BHI, BHV
00
21, C0, C1
0, 1, 3
0, 3
FL + (Density) + SD + (Temp) + H +
(Model Number)
FL + (Density) + SS + (Temp) + F +
(Model Number)
00, 01, G0, G1, R0, R1
00, 01
0, 1, 3
0, 1, 3
0, 3
FL + (Density) + SS + (Temp) + F +
(Model Number)
20, 21, 30, 31, A0, A1, B0,
B1, C0, C1, D0, D1
FL + (Density) + SS + (Temp) + H +
(Model Number)
Note:
1. Example, S25FL256SAGMFI000 package marking would be FL256SAIF00.
2. Contact the factory for additional Extended (-40°C to + 125°C) temperature range OPN offerings.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 142 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Valid Combinations — Automotive Grade / AEC-Q100
The table below lists configurations that are Automotive Grade / AEC-Q100 qualified and are planned to be available in volume. The
table will be updated as new combinations are released. Consult your local sales representative to confirm availability of specific
combinations and to check on newly released combinations.
Production Part Approval Process (PPAP) support is only provided for AEC-Q100 grade products.
Products to be used in end-use applications that require ISO/TS-16949 compliance must be AEC-Q100 grade products in
combination with PPAP. Non–AEC-Q100 grade products are not manufactured or documented in full compliance with
ISO/TS-16949 requirements.
AEC-Q100 grade products are also offered without PPAP support for end-use applications that do not require ISO/TS-16949
compliance.
Table 84. S25FL128S, S25FL256S Valid Combinations — Automotive Grade / AEC-Q100
Valid Combinations — Automotive Grade / AEC-Q100
Base Ordering Speed Package and
Part Number Option Temperature
Packing
Type
Model Number
Package Marking
MFA, MFB,
MFM
00, 01, G0, G1, R0, R1 0, 1, 3 FL + (Density) + SA + (Temp) + F + (Model Number)
NFA, NFB,
AG
00, 01
0, 1, 3 FL + (Density) + SA + (Temp) + F + (Model Number)
0, 3 FL + (Density) + SA + (Temp) + H + (Model Number)
NFM
BHA, BHB,
BHM
20, 21, 30, 31, A0, A1,
B0, B1, C0, C1, D0, D1
NFB
BHB
00
0, 1, 3 FL + (Density) + SD + (Temp) + F + (Model Number)
0, 3 FL + (Density) + SD + (Temp) + H + (Model Number)
S25FL128S or
S25FL256S
DP
DS
21, C0
MFA, MFB,
MFM
00, 01, G0, G1, R0, R1 0, 1, 3 FL + (Density) + SS + (Temp) + F + (Model Number)
NFA, NFB,
NFM
00, 01
0, 1, 3 FL + (Density) + SS + (Temp) + F + (Model Number)
0, 3 FL + (Density) + SS + (Temp) + H + (Model Number)
BHA, BHB,
BHM
20, 21, 30, 31, A0, A1,
B0, B1, C0, C1, D0, D1
13. Contacting Cypress
Obtain the latest list of company locations and contact information at: www.cypress.com/support.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 143 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
14. Revision History
Document Title: S25FL128S/S25FL256S, 128 Mbit (16 Mbyte)/256 Mbit (32 Mbyte) 3.0V SPI Flash Memory
Document Number: 001-98283
Orig. of
Change
Submission
Date
Rev.
ECN No.
Description of Change
**
–
BWHA
05/25/2011
Initial release
Global:
Promoted data sheet to Preliminary status
Corrected minor typos and grammatical errors
Performance Summary:
Updated the Serial Read 50 MHz current consumption value from 14 mA (max) to 16 mA
(max)
Updated the Serial Read 133 MHz current consumption value from 25 mA (max) to 33
mA (max)
Power-Up and Power-DownRemoved the statement “The device draws ICC1 (50 MHz
value) during tPU”
DC Characteristics:
Updated the ICC1Active Power Supply Current (READ) Serial SDR @ 50 MHz maximum
value from 14 mA to 16 mA
Updated the ICC1 Active Power Supply Current (READ) Serial SDR @ 133 MHz
maximum value from 25 mA to 33 mA
SDR AC Characteristics:
Added the tCSH CS# Active Hold Time (Relative to SCK) maximum value of 3000 ns,
with a note indicating that this only applies during the Program/Erase Suspend/Resume
commands
DDR AC Characteristics: Added the tCSH CS# Active Hold Time (Relative to SCK)
maximum value of 3000 ns, with a note indicating that this only applies during the
Program/Erase Suspend/Resume commands
Capacitance Characteristics: Added a Note 1, pointing users to the IBIS models for more
details on capacitance
Physical Interface:
Corrected pin 5 of the SOIC 16 Connection Diagram from NC to DNU
Corrected pin 13 of the SOIC 16 Connection Dig ram from DNU to NC
Replaced the WNF008 drawing with the WNG008 drawing
Updated the FAB024 drawing to the latest version
*A
–
BWHA
11/18/2011
ASP Register: Corrected the statement “The programming time of the ASP Register is
the same as the typical byte programming time” to “The programming time of the ASP
Register is the same as the typical page programming time”
Persistent Protection Bits: Corrected the statement “Programming a PPB bit requires the
typical byte programming time” to “Programming a PPB bit requires the typical page
programming time”
Register Read or Write:
Corrected the statement “…the device remains busy and unable to receive most new
operationcommands.”to“..thedeviceremainsbusy. Underthiscondition, onlytheCLSR,
WRDI, RDSR1, RDSR2, and software RESET commands are valid commands.”
Page Program (PP 02h or 4PP 12h):
Removed the statement “If more than a page of data is sent to the device, previously
latched data are discarded and the last page worth of data (either 256 or 512 bytes) are
programmed in the page. This is the result of the device being equipped with a page
program buffer that is only page size in length.”
Embedded Algorithm Performance Tables:
Updated the t_W WRR Write Time typical value from 100 ms to 140 ms and the maximum
value from 200 ms to 500 ms
Updated t_PP Page Programming Time (256 bytes) maximum value from 550 µs to 750
µs.
Added Note 3 and Note 4 to Table 10.7 to note shared performance values across other
commands
Updated the t_ESL Erase Suspend Latency maximum value from 40 µs to 45 µs.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 144 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Document Title: S25FL128S/S25FL256S, 128 Mbit (16 Mbyte)/256 Mbit (32 Mbyte) 3.0V SPI Flash Memory
Document Number: 001-98283
Orig. of
Change
Submission
Date
Rev.
ECN No.
Description of Change
Device ID and Common Flash Interface (ID-CFI) Address Map:
CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 9Ah - EHPLC DDR table:
corrected the data of offset 01h from 32h to 2Ah
Ordering Information:
Added E0, E1, F0, F1, G0, and G1 as valid model numbers
Broke out the 2 character length model number decoder into separate characters to
clarify format and save space
*A (cont.)
–
BWHA
11/18/2011
Corrected the valid S25FLxxxSAGMFI model numbers from R0 and R1 to G0 and G1
Updated the Package Marking format to help identify speed differences across similar
devices
Added G0 and G1 as valid model number combinations for SDR SOIC OPNs
Removed 20, 21, 30, and 31 as valid model numbers combinations for DDR BGA OPNs
DC Characteristics:
Updated ICC1 values, added note
AC Characteristics:
AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO = VCC 2.7V to 3.6V) table: Moved tSU
value to tCSH, added note
AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO 1.65V to 2.7V, VCC 2.7V to 3.6V) table:
Moved tSU value to tCSH, added note
AC Characteristics 66 MHz Operation table: added note
Command Set Summary:
S25FL128S and S25FL256S Command Set (sorted by function) table: added note
*B
–
BWHA
03/22/2012
Device ID and Common Flash Interface (ID-CFI) Address Map:
Updated CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 0 table
Updated CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 84h Suspend
Commands table
Updated CFI Alternate Vendor-Specific Extended Query Parameter 8Ch Reset Timing
table
Ordering Information:
Valid Combinations table: added BHV to Package and Temperature for Models C0, Do
and C1, D1
SDR AC Characteristics:
*C
*D
–
–
BWHA
BWHA
06/13/2012
07/12/2012
Updated tHO value from 0 Min to 2 ns Min
Global:
Promoted data sheet designation from Preliminary to Full Production
Global:
80 MHz DDR Read operation added
Performance Summary:
Updated Maximum Read Rates DDR (VIO = VCC = 3V to 3.6V) table. Current
Consumption table: added Quad DDR Read 80 MHz.
Migration Notes:
FL Generations Comparison table: updated DDR values for FL-S
*E
–
BWHA
12/20/2013
SDR AC Characteristics:
Updated Clock Timing figure
DDR AC Characteristics:
Updated AC Characteristics — DDR Operation table
DDR Output Timing:
Updated SPI DDR Data Valid Window figure and Notes
Ordering Information:
Added 80 MHz to Speed option. Valid Combinations table: added DS Speed Option.
SDR AC Characteristics:
AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO = VCC 2.7V to 3.6V) table: removed tV min
AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO 1.65V to 2.7V, VCC 2.7V to 3.6V) table:
removed tV min
*F
–
BWHA
03/17/2014
Ordering Information:
Fix typo: Add DDR for 80 MHz for the DS Speed option. Valid Combinations table:
Addition of more OPNs.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 145 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Document Title: S25FL128S/S25FL256S, 128 Mbit (16 Mbyte)/256 Mbit (32 Mbyte) 3.0V SPI Flash Memory
Document Number: 001-98283
Orig. of
Change
Submission
Date
Rev.
ECN No.
Description of Change
Global:
Added Extended Temperature Range: -40°C to 125°C
SDR AC Characteristics:
AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO = VCC 2.7V to 3.6V) table: corrected tSU
Min
Configuration Register 1 (CR1):
Latency Codes for DDR Enhanced High Performance table: added 80 MHz
DDR Fast Read (DDRFR 0Dh, 4DDRFR 0Eh):
*G
–
BWHA
10/10/2014
Updated figures:
Continuous DDR Fast Read Subsequent Access (3-byte Address [ExtAdd=0,
EHPLC=11b])
Continuous DDR Fast Read Subsequent Access (4-byte Address [ExtAdd=1],
EHPLC=01b)
Initial Delivery State:
ASP Register Content table: removed ASPR Default Value row FE4Fh
Ordering Information FL128S and FL256S:
Added Extended Temperature Range: -40°C to 125°C
Updated Valid Combinations table
Global:
Updated description of DDR commands to reflect maximum operating clock frequency
of 80 MHz (from 66 MHz)
Command Set Summary:
S25FL128S and S25FL256S Command Set (sorted by function) table: changed max
DDR frequency from 66 MHz to 80 MHz for all applicable DDR commands
*H
–
BWHA
05/09/2015
Software Interface Reference:
S25FL128S and S25FL256S Instruction Set (sorted by instruction) table: changed max
DDR frequency from 66 MHz to 80 MHz for all applicable DDR commands
Valid Combinations:
Corrected the Package Marking for DS Speed Option
Replaced “Automotive Temperature Range” with “Industrial Plus Temperature Range” in
all instances across the document.
Updated Signal Descriptions:
*I
4871631
BWHA
08/24/2015
Updated Versatile I/O Power Supply (VIO):
Updated description.
Updated to Cypress template.
Added ECC related information in all instances across the document.
Added Automotive Temperature Range related information in all instances across the
document.
Added Logic Block Diagram.
Updated Electrical Specifications:
Added Thermal Resistance.
Updated Operating Ranges:
Updated Table 6:
Updated minimum value of VCC (low) parameter.
Changed minimum value of tPD parameter from 1.0 µs to 15.0 µs.
Updated Timing Specifications:
Updated SDR AC Characteristics:
Updated Table 12:
*J
5348895
TOCU
09/22/2016
Removed Note “For Industrial Plus (-40°C to +105°C) and Extended (-40°C to +125°C)
temperature range, all SCK clock frequencies are 5% slower than the Max values
shown.” and its references.
Updated Table 13:
Removed Note “For Industrial Plus (-40°C to +105°C) and Extended (-40°C to +125°C)
temperature range, all SCK clock frequencies are 5% slower than the Max values
shown.” and its references.
Updated DDR AC Characteristics:
Updated Table 14:
Removed Note “For Industrial Plus (-40°C to +105°C) and Extended (-40°C to +125°C)
temperature range, all SCK clock frequencies are 5% slower than the Max values
shown.” and its references.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 146 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Document Title: S25FL128S/S25FL256S, 128 Mbit (16 Mbyte)/256 Mbit (32 Mbyte) 3.0V SPI Flash Memory
Document Number: 001-98283
Orig. of
Change
Submission
Date
Rev.
ECN No.
Description of Change
Changed minimum value of tHO parameter corresponding to 66 MHz from 0 ns to 1.5 ns.
Updated Address Space Maps:
Updated Registers:
Added ECC Status Register (ECCSR).
Updated Commands:
Updated Command Set Summary:
Updated Extended Addressing:
Updated Table 45:
Removed Note “For Industrial Plus (-40°C to +105°C) and Extended (-40°C to +125°C)
temperature range, all Maximum Frequency values are 5% slower than the Max values
shown.” and its references.
Updated Register Access Commands:
Updated Write Registers (WRR 01h):
Updated description.
*J (cont.)
5348895
TOCU
09/22/2016
Added ECC Status Register Read (ECCRD 18h).
Updated Program Flash Array Commands:
Updated Program Granularity:
Added Automatic ECC.
Added Data Integrity.
Updated Software Interface Reference:
Added Device ID and Common Flash Interface (ID-CFI) ASO Map — Automotive Only.
Updated Ordering Information:
Added Automotive Temperature Range related information in valid combinations.
Updated Valid Combinations — Standard:
Updated Table 83:
Updated entire table.
Added Valid Combinations — Automotive Grade / AEC-Q100.
Updated to new template.
Updated Table 7, DC Characteristics — Operating Temperature Range –40°C to +85°C
on page 26.
Added Table 8, DC Characteristics — Operating Temperature Range -40°C to +105°C
and -40°C to +125°C on page 27.
Updated Section 6.1.2, SOIC 16 Physical Diagram on page 38.
Updated Section 6.2.2, WSON Physical Diagram on page 39.
Updated Section 6.3.2, FAB024 24-Ball BGA Package Physical Diagram on page 41.
Updated Section 6.4.2, FAC024 24-Ball BGA Package Physical Diagram on page 43.
Updated tSU in Table 12, AC Characteristics (Single Die Package, VIO = VCC 2.7V to
3.6V) on page 31.
*K
5662507
ECAO
03/16/2017
Updated Cypress logo and Sales page.
Updated Section 9.5.3, Quad Page Program (QPP 32h or 38h, or 4QPP 34h)
on page 103.
*L
5704165
5746369
BWHA
ECAO
4/27/2017
Updated Sales page.
Updated Cypress logo.
Added Model Number “21” in Table 84, S25FL128S, S25FL256S Valid Combinations —
Automotive Grade / AEC-Q100 on page 143.
*M
05/23/2017
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Page 147 of 148
S25FL128S/S25FL256S
Sales, Solutions, and Legal Information
Worldwide Sales and Design Support
Cypress maintains a worldwide network of offices, solution centers, manufacturer’s representatives, and distributors. To find the office
closest to you, visit us at Cypress Locations.
Products
PSoC® Solutions
ARM® Cortex® Microcontrollers
cypress.com/arm
cypress.com/automotive
cypress.com/clocks
cypress.com/interface
cypress.com/iot
PSoC 1 | PSoC 3 | PSoC 4 | PSoC 5LP | PSoC 6
Automotive
Cypress Developer Community
Clocks & Buffers
Interface
Forums | WICED IOT Forums | Projects | Video | Blogs |
Training | Components
Internet of Things
Memory
Technical Support
cypress.com/memory
cypress.com/mcu
cypress.com/support
Microcontrollers
PSoC
cypress.com/psoc
cypress.com/pmic
cypress.com/touch
cypress.com/usb
Power Management ICs
Touch Sensing
USB Controllers
Wireless Connectivity
cypress.com/wireless
© Cypress Semiconductor Corporation, 2011-2017. This document is the property of Cypress Semiconductor Corporation and its subsidiaries, including Spansion LLC ("Cypress"). This document,
including any software or firmware included or referenced in this document ("Software"), is owned by Cypress under the intellectual property laws and treaties of the United States and other countries
worldwide. Cypress reserves all rights under such laws and treaties and does not, except as specifically stated in this paragraph, grant any license under its patents, copyrights, trademarks, or other
intellectual property rights. If the Software is not accompanied by a license agreement and you do not otherwise have a written agreement with Cypress governing the use of the Software, then Cypress
hereby grants you a personal, non-exclusive, nontransferable license (without the right to sublicense) (1) under its copyright rights in the Software (a) for Software provided in source code form, to
modify and reproduce the Software solely for use with Cypress hardware products, only internally within your organization, and (b) to distribute the Software in binary code form externally to end users
(either directly or indirectly through resellers and distributors), solely for use on Cypress hardware product units, and (2) under those claims of Cypress's patents that are infringed by the Software (as
provided by Cypress, unmodified) to make, use, distribute, and import the Software solely for use with Cypress hardware products. Any other use, reproduction, modification, translation, or compilation
of the Software is prohibited.
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, CYPRESS MAKES NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH REGARD TO THIS DOCUMENT OR ANY SOFTWARE
OR ACCOMPANYING HARDWARE, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. To the extent
permitted by applicable law, Cypress reserves the right to make changes to this document without further notice. Cypress does not assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any
product or circuit described in this document. Any information provided in this document, including any sample design information or programming code, is provided only for reference purposes. It is
the responsibility of the user of this document to properly design, program, and test the functionality and safety of any application made of this information and any resulting product. Cypress products
are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as critical components in systems designed or intended for the operation of weapons, weapons systems, nuclear installations, life-support devices or
systems, other medical devices or systems (including resuscitation equipment and surgical implants), pollution control or hazardous substances management, or other uses where the failure of the
device or system could cause personal injury, death, or property damage ("Unintended Uses"). A critical component is any component of a device or system whose failure to perform can be reasonably
expected to cause the failure of the device or system, or to affect its safety or effectiveness. Cypress is not liable, in whole or in part, and you shall and hereby do release Cypress from any claim,
damage, or other liability arising from or related to all Unintended Uses of Cypress products. You shall indemnify and hold Cypress harmless from and against all claims, costs, damages, and other
liabilities, including claims for personal injury or death, arising from or related to any Unintended Uses of Cypress products.
Cypress, the Cypress logo, Spansion, the Spansion logo, and combinations thereof, WICED, PSoC, CapSense, EZ-USB, F-RAM, and Traveo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cypress in
the United States and other countries. For a more complete list of Cypress trademarks, visit cypress.com. Other names and brands may be claimed as property of their respective owners.
Document Number: 001-98283 Rev. *M
Revised May 23, 2017
Page 148 of 148
相关型号:
S25FL256SAGMFVG11
MirrorBit Flash Non-Volatile Memory CMOS 3.0 Volt Core with Versatile I/O Serial Peripheral Interface with Multi-I/O
SPANSION
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明